Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Ford
Model
Courier
Engine and year
L4-2299cc (1982)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by System > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes Engine Controls > System Information > System Diagnosis > Transmisson Codes
A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes - Engine Controls: Testing and Inspection Transmisson Codes
For Transmission related codes, proceed to Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by System > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes Trans and Drivetrain > System Information > System Diagnosis
A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes - Trans and Drivetrain: Testing and Inspection
For Transmission related codes, proceed to Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Control Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 - Spark Timing Control System
This system, Fig. 37, used on 1977-78 1.8 liter, 1979-82 2.0 liter and 1981-82 2.3 liter California
with manual transmission models reduces exhaust emissions by delaying vacuum to the distributor
vacuum advance unit during vehicle acceleration.
The system consists of a vacuum delay valve installed in the vacuum line between the carburetor
and distributor on 1.8 liter and 2.0 liter engines except California, or between the water thermo
valve and distributor on 2.0 liter California engines. On 2.3 liter engines, the system consists of a
spark delay valve (manual transmission equipped models) and a distributor solenoid valve installed
in the vacuum line between the intake manifold and distributor. The distributor solenoid valve is
controlled by a timer and water thermo switch (also a distributor water thermo switch on vehicles
with automatic transmission).
The spark delay valve has an internal restrictor to slow air flow in one direction and a check valve
which allows free air flow in the opposite direction.
On 1979-82 California models, distributor vacuum advance is restricted by the water thermo valve
which detects engine coolant temperature. This helps to warm up the catalytic converter.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Delay Valve
Spark Delay Valve, 1977-80, 1980-82 exc. Calif.
1. Remove air cleaner and disconnect vacuum line from distributor.
Fig. 38 - Spark Delay Valve Test
2. On 1977-78, disconnect vacuum control line at intake manifold fitting and install distributor
vacuum line to intake manifold fitting, Fig. 38.
Fig. 39 - Spark Delay Valve Test
Fig. 40 - Spark Delay Valve Test
3. On 1979-82, disconnect air bypass line on California models, Figs. 39 and 40, or air
anti-afterburn valve on except California models and connect
distributor vacuum line disconnected previously to intake manifold fitting.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 19
Fig. 41 - Spark Delay Valve Test
4. Remove vacuum line from carburetor side of vacuum delay valve, then plug in and connect a
vacuum gauge to vacuum delay valve, Figs. 39, 40
and 41.
5. Start engine and allow to idle.
6. Disconnect vacuum line from intake manifold fitting.
NOTE:The time required for vacuum reading to drop to 11.8 inches Hg. If amount of time is not
within 4-6 seconds, replace valve.
Spark Delay Valve, 1981-82 2.3L Calif, 1982 2.OL Calif.
Fig. 42 - Spark Delay Valve Test
1. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor solenoid and connect a
vacuum gauge to tube.
NOTE: On 1982 vehicles, add a 30mm vacuum reservoir between spark delay valve and vacuum
gauge.
2. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor vacuum advance unit and
connect tube to intake manifold.
3. Start engine and note vacuum reading at idle.
4. Disconnect tube from intake manifold and check time required for vacuum reading to drop
decrease by 11.8 inches Hg. vacuum. Time required
should be 5 ± 1 seconds.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 20
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Distributor Solenoid Valve
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Separate connector at distributor solenoid valve and apply battery voltage to the two terminals to
energize the solenoid.
3. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from distributor solenoid valve at distributor vacuum advance.
4. Disconnect battery power from solenoid. Solenoid is functioning properly if vacuum is drawn into
vacuum sensing tube when battery is
disconnected.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 21
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Control Timer
Timer Test, 2.3L Calif.
Fig. 43 - Timer Test
1. Remove timer.
2. Connect suitable test wires to timer terminals A, B and C respectively.
3. Connect a suitable test wire with a 30K ohm resistor to terminal D.
4. Connect a suitable test wire with a 3.4 watt lamp to terminal E.
5. Connect positive leads of a voltmeter to terminal D and negative test lead to battery negative
terminal.
6. Connect test wires from timer terminals A, D and E to battery positive terminal. Do not connect
test wire from terminal B at this time.
7. Connect wire from terminal C to battery negative terminal.
8. Voltmeter should not read 6 volts.
9. Connect test wire from timer terminal B with battery positive terminal. At the instant the
connection is made, the volt. meter should read less than
1 volt and lamp should illuminate. Maintain this connection for 125 ± 15 seconds. Voltmeter should
read 8 volts.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 22
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Water Thermo Switch
Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L Calif.
1. Remove thermo switch.
2. Connect an ohmmeter across the switch terminals and place sensor end of switch in a water
filled container. Place a thermometer into water and
gradually heat water while observing thermometer.
3. Note temperature at which continuity exists between switch terminals. The specified temperature
is 131 ±4°F. Replace switch if temperature is not
within specifications.
Distributor Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L With Auto. Trans., Calif.
The procedure to test this switch is the same as the one described previously for the Water Thermo
Switch, 2.3L Calif. However, the specified temperature is 50 ±4°F or above.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Specifications Switch Torque
Switch Torque
Cooling Fan Switch 8-18 ft.lb
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Washer Fluid Level Switch: >
84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Customer Interest Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Washer Fluid
Level Switch: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light
Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications
Alignment: Specifications
Caster
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... +3/4° - 1 1/4°
Camber
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... +1/2° - 1 1/4°
Toe-inches
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 0" - 1/4"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE
Pump Pressure ....................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 2.8 - 3.6 psi
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > System Information > Service Precautions
Hoses: Service Precautions
SERVICE PRECAUTIONS
To prevent vehicle damage, always observe the following precautions: After servicing a hose, check for leaks before and after test driving the vehicle.
- Always use the correct size hose. Do not use standard sized hose in place of metric hose or vice
versa.
Always use the correct type of hose. Never use vacuum hose in place of fuel hose. Never use
heater hose in place of PCV hose.
- When replacing hoses which are attached to the engine on one end and the frame or body on the
other end, always leave sufficient length to compensate for engine movement (from torque).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips
Article No. 95-18-2
09/11/95
^ COOLANT - USE OF RECYCLED ENGINE, COOLANT - SERVICE TIP
^ COOLING SYSTEM - USE OF RECYCLED ENGINE, COOLANT - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 1980 and after CROWN VICTORIA, MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1981 and after ESCORT
1982-88 EXP 1984-94 TEMPO 1986 and after TAURUS 1988-93 FESTIVA 1989 and after PROBE
1994 and after ASPIRE 1995 and after CONTOUR
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980 and after CONTINENTAL, COUGAR, GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN
CAR 1981-86 CAPRI 1981-87 LYNX 1984-92 MARK VII 1984-94 TOPAZ 1986 and after SABLE
1987-89 TRACER 1991-94 CAPRI 1991 and after TRACER 1993 and after MARK VIII 1995 and
after MYSTIQUE
MERKUR: 1985-89 XR4TI 1988-89 SCORPIO
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980 and after F-150-350 SERIES 1981 and after ECONOLINE 1982 and after
BRONCO 1983 and after RANGER 1984-90 BRONCO II 1986 and after AEROSTAR 1988 and
after F SUPER DUTY 1991 and after EXPLORER 1993 and after VILLAGER 1995 and after
WINDSTAR
This TSB is being republished in its entirety to include warranty information when using recycled
coolant
ISSUE: Ford Motor Company authorizes the use of recycled engine coolant that, when properly
processed and reinhibited, meets Ford specification ESE-M97B44-A. At this time, the Rotunda
Coolant Recycler (181-00003) process is the only approved coolant recycling method available
through Ford that is capable of producing recycled engine coolant that meets Ford specification
ESE-M97B44-A.
ACTION: Refer to the following Service Procedure for coolant processing and reinhibiting using
Rotunda Coolant Recycler (181-00003).
NOTE:
WHILE TESTING SHOWS THAT RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT CAN PROVIDE ACCEPTABLE
PERFORMANCE, THE COOLANT PRODUCED FROM ROTUNDA EQUIPMENT IS INTENDED
FOR USE WITHIN DEALERSHIPS ON WARRANTY AND CUSTOMER PAY REPAIRS ONLY
AND NOT INTENDED FOR RETAIL SALE. THERE ARE REGULATORY, PACKAGING AND
LABELING CONCERNS
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips > Page 68
ASSOCIATED WITH THE RETAIL SALE OF CHEMICAL PRODUCTS.
CAUTION:
THE REINHIBITOR CHEMICALS PROVIDED WITH THIS EQUIPMENT ARE NOT
APPROPRIATE FOR USE ON MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK APPLICATIONS.
WARNING:
ROTUNDA PREMIUM COOLANT REINHIBITORS # 1 AND # 2 HAVE BEEN SPECIFICALLY
FORMULATED TO WORK WITH ROTUNDA COOLANT RECYCLER (181-00003).
USE OF ANY OTHER CHEMICAL ADDITIVES WITH THIS SYSTEM WILL VOID ALL
WARRANTIES FOR THE EQUIPMENT AND FOR THE FINAL COOLANT PRODUCT.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
DIRECTIONS FOR PROCESSING USED ENGINE COOLANT WITH ROTUNDA COOLANT
RECYCLER
1. Close the drain valve on the unit.
2. Open the fill valve.
3. Pour used engine coolant into the funnel on the side of the unit.
NOTE:
MAXIMUM CAPACITY 15 25 GALLONS (95 L).
4. Insert the outlet hoses of the recycler into clean, properly labeled containers. One (1) container
is for the outlet process water and the other container is for distilled ethylene glycol.
5. Push the "ON" switch on the front to start the operation. The unit will process 1 gallon (3.8 L) per
hour of operation and will automatically shut off when cycle is complete.
6. Add reinhibitor following the directions in this article.
7. Open the drain valve to drain the residue from the distillation vessel. Dispose of residue in
accordance with all local. state and federal regulations.
ADDING REINHIBITOR CHEMICALS
1. Process the coolant according to the directions listed in this article
2. Thoroughly mix 4 fl oz (118 ml) of Reinhibitor # 1 to each gallon of distilled ethylene glycol.
3. Thoroughly mix 4 fl oz (118 ml) of Reinhibitor # 2 to each gallon of distilled ethylene glycol.
4. Mix well.
5. Check the pH level of the coolant. The pH level must be between 9 and 11.
6. Add enough water to the concentrated coolant to produce a 50/50 mixture of coolant and water.
NOTE:
THE CONCENTRATED COOLANT MUST BE MIXED WITH WATER TO MEET THE
NECESSARY ENGINE FREEZE PROTECTION.
7. Check the coolant freeze point of the 50% coolant solution. Freeze point should be -34°F
(-37°C).
Consult the Rotunda Coolant Recycler Manual for more detailed operating instructions. Call
1-800-ROTUNDA, 8 AM to 8 PM EST, for inquiries regarding the Rotunda Coolant Recycler and to
order the Reinhibitor (187-R0001).
PART NUMBER PART NAME
Rotunda # 187-R0001 Rotunda Premium Coolant Reinhibitor
WARRANTY CLAIMS: Dealer can claim recycled engine coolant by Ford approved process via a
warranty repair on an 1863 claim as follows:
Part Number: RECCOOL (not a valid part number, but it is recognized on an 1863 claim).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips > Page 69
Quantity: Indicate the number of QUARTS of recycled coolant used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE SUPERSEDES: 95-16-6 WARRANTY STATUS:
INFORMATION ONLY OASIS CODES: 402000
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity 8.8 qts
..............................................................................................................................................................
.........................................
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 72
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM FLUID, PREMIUM
Ford Part No.
U.S.A (Except Oregon)
............................................................................................................................................................
E2FZ-19549-AA or -B Canada ............................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. CXC-8-B Oregon ..................................
.............................................................................................................................................................
F5FZ-19549-CC
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................... ESE-M97B44-A
COOLING SYSTEM FLUSH
Ford Part No. .......................................................................................................................................
................................................... F1AZ-19A503-A Ford Specification .................................................
..................................................................................................................................... ESR-M14P7-A
Coolant Mixture with Water .................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 50%
Warning: Do not mix coolant types. Check the owners manual or refer to your local dealer for the
correct coolant type.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Engine - Oil Level Checking Procedure
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Level Checking Procedure
Article No. 85-25-20
OIL DIPSTICK - ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECKING PROCEDURE - GASOLINE ENGINES
LIGHT TRUCK 1986 AND PRIOR
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK 1986 AND PRIOR
Figure 17 - Dipstick
To correctly check the engine oil level, the vehicle must be parked on a level surface. Allow a few
minutes after shutting the engine off for oil to drain down before checking. For consistent oil level
readings, insert the dipstick with the loop of the handle as shown in Figure 17.
Figure 18 - Dipstick - Calibration
Figure 19 - Dipstick - Calibration
Dipsticks in Ford vehicles do not incorporate a Full mark. Instead, the dipstick will have marks
indicating a Safe range and an Add range as shown in Figure 18 or 19. When the correct amount
of oil is in the engine, the oil level indication will be in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark,
but not necessarily at the top of the Safe range or at the Maximum mark.
When the indicated oil level is in the Add range put one quart of oil in the engine. Recheck the oil
level to determine if the oil level is now in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark.
Add and recheck oil level one quart at a time until the oil level indicator moves into the Safe range
or above the Minimum mark. Do not add additional oil to bring the level to the top of the Safe range
or to the Maximum mark since this may result in overfill and increased oil consumption. If the
accuracy of the engine oil dipstick is in doubt, it may be verified in the following manner:
^ Drain the oil and install a new filter.
^ Put in the specified amount of oil for an oil and filter change. (See owner guide)
^ Start the engine and operate a few minutes.
^ Shut off the engine and allow a few minutes for the oil to drain down.
^ Check the oil level with the dipstick.
^ If the oil level does not indicate in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark, rework or replace
the dipstick.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air
Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Air Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye
Article No. 93-20-6
09/29/93
AIR CONDITIONING - USE OF CORRECT FLUORESCENT TRACER DYE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 1980-93 CROWN VICTORIA 1981-93 ESCORT 1982-83 FAIRMONT 1982-88 EXP
1982-93 MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1983-86 LTD 1984-93 TEMPO 1986-93 TAURUS 1988-93
FESTIVA 1989-93 PROBE
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-93 GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN CAR 1981-87 LYNX 1982-83 LN7,
ZEPHYR 1982-86 CAPRI 1982-93 CONTINENTAL, COUGAR 1983-86 MARQUIS 1984-92 MARK
VII 1984-93 TOPAZ 1986-93 SABLE 1991-93 CAPRI, TRACER
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-93 BRONCO, ECONOLINE, F-150-350 SERIES 1983-93 RANGER 1984-90
BRONCO II 1986-93 AEROSTAR 1988-93 F-47 1991-93 EXPLORER 1993 VILLAGER
ISSUE: Use of untested, unapproved fluorescent tracer dyes for A/C system leak checking may
damage the air conditioning system. Some of these materials may not be compatible with Ford A/C
systems.
ACTION: When leak-checking an R-12 A/C system with a "black light", use only Rotunda-supplied
Part No. 112-R0027, Fluoro-Lite brand dye. No other dyes have been approved by Ford Motor
Company.
NOTE: 112-R0027 DYE IS NOT COMPATIBLE WITH R-134a REFRIGERANT.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS
CODES: 208999
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air
Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye > Page 81
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins R-12 Refrigerant - Substitutes
Article No. 94-14-3
07/13/94
Air Conditioning - Use Of R-12 Refrigerant Substitutes - Service Tip
FORD: 1980-93 CROWN VICTORIA 1981-93 ESCORT 1982-83 FAIRMONT 1982-88 EXP
1982-93 MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1983-86 LTD 1984-93 TEMPO 1986-93 TAURUS 1988-93
FESTIVA 1989-93 PROBE
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-93 GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN CAR 1981-87 LYNX 1982-83 LN7,
ZEPHYR 1982-86 CAPRI 1982-93 CONTINENTAL, COUGAR 1983-86 MARQUIS 1984-92 MARK
VII 1984-93 TOPAZ 1986-93 SABLE 1991-93 CAPRI, TRACER
MERKUR: 1986-89 SCORPIO, XR4TI
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-93 BRONCO, ECONOLINE, F-150-350 SERIES 1983-93 RANGER 1984-90
BRONCO II 1986-93 AEROSTAR 1988-93 F-47 1991-93 EXPLORER 1992-94 F-53 1993
VILLAGER
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1954-90 C SERIES 1970-94 L SERIES 1979-90 CL-9000,
CL-CLT-9000 SERIES 1980-94 F SERIES 1986-94 CARGO SERIES
This TSB is being republished in its entirety to include Heavy Truck models.
ISSUE:
A number of manufacturers are producing refrigerant products which are described as being direct
replacements for refrigerant R-12. The use of any unauthorized substitute refrigerant may severely
damage the A/C system components.
ACTION:
If service is required, use only NEW or RECYCLED refrigerant R-12.
Ford Motor Company has not tested or approved any R-12 refrigerant substitute at this time.
R-134a is approved only for systems which specify R-134a,
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air
Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye > Page 82
and is not compatible with R-12 systems.
R-22 likewise, is not compatible with R-12 systems.
CAUTION:
USING ANY UNAUTHORIZED SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT FOR R-12 MAY RESULT IN
SEVERE DAMAGE TO THE A/C SYSTEM COMPONENTS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 91-9-7
SUPERSEDES: 93-23-11
WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY
OASIS CODES: 208000, 208999, 290000
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 83
Refrigerant: Specifications
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... Refrigerant 12 (R-12) Ford Part Number .............................................
........................................................................................................................................
D4AZ-19B519-A
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Specifications
Compressor ................................................................................................................... 500 viscosity
(C9AZ-19557-B or Motorcraft VN-2 or equivalent)
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuses and Circuit Breakers: Service Precautions
FUSE AND CIRCUIT BREAKER PRECAUTIONS
When replacing a blown fuse or defective circuit breaker, it is important to use only a fuse or circuit
breaker having the correct amperage rating. The use of a fuse or circuit breaker with a rating other
than indicated may result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If a properly rated fuse or
circuit breaker continues to blow or trip, it indicates a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > EGR Maintenance Light > Component Information
> Service and Repair
EGR Maintenance Light: Service and Repair
EGR Warning Switch Reset
NOTE:
After performing the necessary EGR system maintenance, the EGR warning lamp switch can be
reset. The switch is installed behind the speedometer and is reset as follows:
Procedure
1. Remove cover from switch.
2. Slide the switch knob to the opposite position and the warning lamp will go out.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Oil Level Checking Procedure
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Level Checking Procedure
Article No. 85-25-20
OIL DIPSTICK - ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECKING PROCEDURE - GASOLINE ENGINES
LIGHT TRUCK 1986 AND PRIOR
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK 1986 AND PRIOR
Figure 17 - Dipstick
To correctly check the engine oil level, the vehicle must be parked on a level surface. Allow a few
minutes after shutting the engine off for oil to drain down before checking. For consistent oil level
readings, insert the dipstick with the loop of the handle as shown in Figure 17.
Figure 18 - Dipstick - Calibration
Figure 19 - Dipstick - Calibration
Dipsticks in Ford vehicles do not incorporate a Full mark. Instead, the dipstick will have marks
indicating a Safe range and an Add range as shown in Figure 18 or 19. When the correct amount
of oil is in the engine, the oil level indication will be in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark,
but not necessarily at the top of the Safe range or at the Maximum mark.
When the indicated oil level is in the Add range put one quart of oil in the engine. Recheck the oil
level to determine if the oil level is now in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark.
Add and recheck oil level one quart at a time until the oil level indicator moves into the Safe range
or above the Minimum mark. Do not add additional oil to bring the level to the top of the Safe range
or to the Maximum mark since this may result in overfill and increased oil consumption. If the
accuracy of the engine oil dipstick is in doubt, it may be verified in the following manner:
^ Drain the oil and install a new filter.
^ Put in the specified amount of oil for an oil and filter change. (See owner guide)
^ Start the engine and operate a few minutes.
^ Shut off the engine and allow a few minutes for the oil to drain down.
^ Check the oil level with the dipstick.
^ If the oil level does not indicate in the Safe range or above the Minimum mark, rework or replace
the dipstick.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Crankshaft Seal - Leaks, Air Pressure Test
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Technical Service Bulletins Crankshaft Seal - Leaks, Air Pressure
Test
Article No. 86-3-14
LEAK OIL - CRANKSHAFT SEAL - AIR PRESSURE TEST
FORD 1986 and Prior FORD, THUNDERBIRD, LTD, ESCORT, FAIRMONT, MUSTANG, EXP,
TAURUS
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1986 and Prior LINCOLN, MARK, CONTINENTAL, MERCURY, MARQUIS,
COUGAR, CAPRI, LYNX, LN7, SABLE
LIGHT TRUCK 1986 and Prior RANGER, BRONCO II, AEROSTAR, E AND F SERIES
To prevent repeat servicing on engines suspected of oil leakage at the crankshaft seal, determine if
the leak is actually from the seal or from another source such as the rear pan seal or galley plugs.
The one-piece rear crankshaft seal is released for all passenger car and light truck engines and
has proven to be more reliable than the rope or split lip design formerly used.
Performing the oil leak air pressure check outlined in all Car and Truck Powertrain Shop Manuals,
Section 21- 01 will accurately identify the location of the leak and can verify correction after
servicing before the transmission is reinstalled.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 80-15-5, 83-14-8 WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION
ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE
Pump Pressure ....................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 2.8 - 3.6 psi
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips
Article No. 95-18-2
09/11/95
^ COOLANT - USE OF RECYCLED ENGINE, COOLANT - SERVICE TIP
^ COOLING SYSTEM - USE OF RECYCLED ENGINE, COOLANT - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 1980 and after CROWN VICTORIA, MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1981 and after ESCORT
1982-88 EXP 1984-94 TEMPO 1986 and after TAURUS 1988-93 FESTIVA 1989 and after PROBE
1994 and after ASPIRE 1995 and after CONTOUR
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980 and after CONTINENTAL, COUGAR, GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN
CAR 1981-86 CAPRI 1981-87 LYNX 1984-92 MARK VII 1984-94 TOPAZ 1986 and after SABLE
1987-89 TRACER 1991-94 CAPRI 1991 and after TRACER 1993 and after MARK VIII 1995 and
after MYSTIQUE
MERKUR: 1985-89 XR4TI 1988-89 SCORPIO
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980 and after F-150-350 SERIES 1981 and after ECONOLINE 1982 and after
BRONCO 1983 and after RANGER 1984-90 BRONCO II 1986 and after AEROSTAR 1988 and
after F SUPER DUTY 1991 and after EXPLORER 1993 and after VILLAGER 1995 and after
WINDSTAR
This TSB is being republished in its entirety to include warranty information when using recycled
coolant
ISSUE: Ford Motor Company authorizes the use of recycled engine coolant that, when properly
processed and reinhibited, meets Ford specification ESE-M97B44-A. At this time, the Rotunda
Coolant Recycler (181-00003) process is the only approved coolant recycling method available
through Ford that is capable of producing recycled engine coolant that meets Ford specification
ESE-M97B44-A.
ACTION: Refer to the following Service Procedure for coolant processing and reinhibiting using
Rotunda Coolant Recycler (181-00003).
NOTE:
WHILE TESTING SHOWS THAT RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT CAN PROVIDE ACCEPTABLE
PERFORMANCE, THE COOLANT PRODUCED FROM ROTUNDA EQUIPMENT IS INTENDED
FOR USE WITHIN DEALERSHIPS ON WARRANTY AND CUSTOMER PAY REPAIRS ONLY
AND NOT INTENDED FOR RETAIL SALE. THERE ARE REGULATORY, PACKAGING AND
LABELING CONCERNS
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips > Page 119
ASSOCIATED WITH THE RETAIL SALE OF CHEMICAL PRODUCTS.
CAUTION:
THE REINHIBITOR CHEMICALS PROVIDED WITH THIS EQUIPMENT ARE NOT
APPROPRIATE FOR USE ON MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK APPLICATIONS.
WARNING:
ROTUNDA PREMIUM COOLANT REINHIBITORS # 1 AND # 2 HAVE BEEN SPECIFICALLY
FORMULATED TO WORK WITH ROTUNDA COOLANT RECYCLER (181-00003).
USE OF ANY OTHER CHEMICAL ADDITIVES WITH THIS SYSTEM WILL VOID ALL
WARRANTIES FOR THE EQUIPMENT AND FOR THE FINAL COOLANT PRODUCT.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
DIRECTIONS FOR PROCESSING USED ENGINE COOLANT WITH ROTUNDA COOLANT
RECYCLER
1. Close the drain valve on the unit.
2. Open the fill valve.
3. Pour used engine coolant into the funnel on the side of the unit.
NOTE:
MAXIMUM CAPACITY 15 25 GALLONS (95 L).
4. Insert the outlet hoses of the recycler into clean, properly labeled containers. One (1) container
is for the outlet process water and the other container is for distilled ethylene glycol.
5. Push the "ON" switch on the front to start the operation. The unit will process 1 gallon (3.8 L) per
hour of operation and will automatically shut off when cycle is complete.
6. Add reinhibitor following the directions in this article.
7. Open the drain valve to drain the residue from the distillation vessel. Dispose of residue in
accordance with all local. state and federal regulations.
ADDING REINHIBITOR CHEMICALS
1. Process the coolant according to the directions listed in this article
2. Thoroughly mix 4 fl oz (118 ml) of Reinhibitor # 1 to each gallon of distilled ethylene glycol.
3. Thoroughly mix 4 fl oz (118 ml) of Reinhibitor # 2 to each gallon of distilled ethylene glycol.
4. Mix well.
5. Check the pH level of the coolant. The pH level must be between 9 and 11.
6. Add enough water to the concentrated coolant to produce a 50/50 mixture of coolant and water.
NOTE:
THE CONCENTRATED COOLANT MUST BE MIXED WITH WATER TO MEET THE
NECESSARY ENGINE FREEZE PROTECTION.
7. Check the coolant freeze point of the 50% coolant solution. Freeze point should be -34°F
(-37°C).
Consult the Rotunda Coolant Recycler Manual for more detailed operating instructions. Call
1-800-ROTUNDA, 8 AM to 8 PM EST, for inquiries regarding the Rotunda Coolant Recycler and to
order the Reinhibitor (187-R0001).
PART NUMBER PART NAME
Rotunda # 187-R0001 Rotunda Premium Coolant Reinhibitor
WARRANTY CLAIMS: Dealer can claim recycled engine coolant by Ford approved process via a
warranty repair on an 1863 claim as follows:
Part Number: RECCOOL (not a valid part number, but it is recognized on an 1863 claim).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recycled Engine Coolant - Service Tips > Page 120
Quantity: Indicate the number of QUARTS of recycled coolant used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE SUPERSEDES: 95-16-6 WARRANTY STATUS:
INFORMATION ONLY OASIS CODES: 402000
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity 8.8 qts
..............................................................................................................................................................
.........................................
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 123
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM FLUID, PREMIUM
Ford Part No.
U.S.A (Except Oregon)
............................................................................................................................................................
E2FZ-19549-AA or -B Canada ............................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. CXC-8-B Oregon ..................................
.............................................................................................................................................................
F5FZ-19549-CC
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................... ESE-M97B44-A
COOLING SYSTEM FLUSH
Ford Part No. .......................................................................................................................................
................................................... F1AZ-19A503-A Ford Specification .................................................
..................................................................................................................................... ESR-M14P7-A
Coolant Mixture with Water .................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 50%
Warning: Do not mix coolant types. Check the owners manual or refer to your local dealer for the
correct coolant type.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Specifications Switch Torque
Switch Torque
Cooling Fan Switch 8-18 ft.lb
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Specifications Switch Torque
Switch Torque
Cooling Fan Switch 8-18 ft.lb
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips
Article No. 85-8-2
HEATER CORE - LEAK - DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
Good heater cores are being returned through the parts return system coded as leaking.
Complaints of leaking may be caused by an inadequate seal between the heater hose and the
heater core tubes allowing coolant to follow the tube to the heater core, leak into the passenger
compartment and appear as a leaking heater core.
When diagnosing a suspect heater core leak, inspect the hose to heater core tube attachment to
assure the connection is not leaking. If a leaking connection is found, correct the leak. If the
connection appears not to be leaking, leak test the heater core before removing it from the vehicle
using the following procedure:
HEATER CORE LEAK TEST
Pressure Test 1.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater hoses from the heater core tubes.
3. Install a short piece of heater hose (approximately 4 inches long) on each heater core tube.
Figure 1
4. Fill the heater core and hoses with water and install plug BT-7422-B and adapter BT-7422-A
from Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent in the hose ends (Figure 1). Secure the hoses, plug
and adapter with hose clamps.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips > Page 136
Figure 2
Figure 3 - TOOL 021-00012 WITH HEATER HOSE AND CLAMPS
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent to the adapter
(Figure 2). Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge and pump 30 psi of air pressure into the
heater core (Figure 3).
6. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of three minutes. The pressure should not drop.
7. If the pressure does not drop, no leaks are indicated.
8. If the pressure drops, check the hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the hoses do not
leak, remove the heater core from the vehicle and perform the bench test.
Bench Test 1.
Drain all coolant from the heater core.
Figure 4 - HEATER CORE BENCH TEST
2. Connect the 4-inch test hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes. Then connect the air
pump and gauge assembly to the adapter (Figure 4).
3. Apply 30 psi of air pressure to the heater core with Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent, and
submerge the core in water.
4. If a leak is observed, service or replace the heater core as necessary.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips > Page 137
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Specifications Switch Torque
Switch Torque
Cooling Fan Switch 8-18 ft.lb
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Some 1976-82 vehicles use a catalytic converter to reduce hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide
exhaust emission levels. These vehicles are also equipped with a catalyst warning system. This
system is comprised of a thermo sensor on the catalytic converter, monitoring converter
temperature, and a warning lamp on the instrument panel which illuminates when the thermo
sensor detects converter temperatures over 1742°F.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 147
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
Warning System Test
1. Turn ignition switch to "On" position. The warning lamp should illuminate, indicating that the bulb
and electrical wiring are satisfactory. If lamp
does not light, check bulb.
2. Start engine and if the system is satisfactory, the warning lamp should go out. If not, stop engine
and tilt the seatback forward.
Fig. 31 - Catalyst Warning System Test
3. Disconnect the catalytic converter thermo sensor electrical connectors, Fig. 31.
4. With an ohmmeter, check the circuit on the thermo sensor side of the wiring for continuity, Fig.
31. Replace the thermo sensor if the reading
indicates no continuity.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Muffler - Unnecessary Replacement
Muffler: Technical Service Bulletins Muffler - Unnecessary Replacement
Article No. 83-11-11
EXHAUST - MUFFLER - POWER LOW - UNNECESSARY MUFFLER REPLACEMENT
LIGHT TRUCKS 1982 AND LATER LIGHT TRUCKS
Mufflers are being replaced on leaded fuel vehicles in an effort to resolve concerns of "lack of
power" or poor performance", apparently in the belief that a plugged muffler is the cause. Although
plugging with lead deposits was possible on certain models prior to the 1982 Model Year, muffler
modifications incorporated on 1982 and later models make this an unlikely cause of the concern.
Thus, replacing mufflers on the newer model vehicles normally will not satisfy the customer. Prior
to replacing any muffler believed to be restricted, a vacuum check as described in Section 26-01 of
the Light Truck Shop Manual should be performed.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Control Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 - Spark Timing Control System
This system, Fig. 37, used on 1977-78 1.8 liter, 1979-82 2.0 liter and 1981-82 2.3 liter California
with manual transmission models reduces exhaust emissions by delaying vacuum to the distributor
vacuum advance unit during vehicle acceleration.
The system consists of a vacuum delay valve installed in the vacuum line between the carburetor
and distributor on 1.8 liter and 2.0 liter engines except California, or between the water thermo
valve and distributor on 2.0 liter California engines. On 2.3 liter engines, the system consists of a
spark delay valve (manual transmission equipped models) and a distributor solenoid valve installed
in the vacuum line between the intake manifold and distributor. The distributor solenoid valve is
controlled by a timer and water thermo switch (also a distributor water thermo switch on vehicles
with automatic transmission).
The spark delay valve has an internal restrictor to slow air flow in one direction and a check valve
which allows free air flow in the opposite direction.
On 1979-82 California models, distributor vacuum advance is restricted by the water thermo valve
which detects engine coolant temperature. This helps to warm up the catalytic converter.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Delay Valve
Spark Delay Valve, 1977-80, 1980-82 exc. Calif.
1. Remove air cleaner and disconnect vacuum line from distributor.
Fig. 38 - Spark Delay Valve Test
2. On 1977-78, disconnect vacuum control line at intake manifold fitting and install distributor
vacuum line to intake manifold fitting, Fig. 38.
Fig. 39 - Spark Delay Valve Test
Fig. 40 - Spark Delay Valve Test
3. On 1979-82, disconnect air bypass line on California models, Figs. 39 and 40, or air
anti-afterburn valve on except California models and connect
distributor vacuum line disconnected previously to intake manifold fitting.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve >
Page 160
Fig. 41 - Spark Delay Valve Test
4. Remove vacuum line from carburetor side of vacuum delay valve, then plug in and connect a
vacuum gauge to vacuum delay valve, Figs. 39, 40
and 41.
5. Start engine and allow to idle.
6. Disconnect vacuum line from intake manifold fitting.
NOTE:The time required for vacuum reading to drop to 11.8 inches Hg. If amount of time is not
within 4-6 seconds, replace valve.
Spark Delay Valve, 1981-82 2.3L Calif, 1982 2.OL Calif.
Fig. 42 - Spark Delay Valve Test
1. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor solenoid and connect a
vacuum gauge to tube.
NOTE: On 1982 vehicles, add a 30mm vacuum reservoir between spark delay valve and vacuum
gauge.
2. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor vacuum advance unit and
connect tube to intake manifold.
3. Start engine and note vacuum reading at idle.
4. Disconnect tube from intake manifold and check time required for vacuum reading to drop
decrease by 11.8 inches Hg. vacuum. Time required
should be 5 ± 1 seconds.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve >
Page 161
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Distributor Solenoid Valve
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Separate connector at distributor solenoid valve and apply battery voltage to the two terminals to
energize the solenoid.
3. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from distributor solenoid valve at distributor vacuum advance.
4. Disconnect battery power from solenoid. Solenoid is functioning properly if vacuum is drawn into
vacuum sensing tube when battery is
disconnected.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve >
Page 162
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Control Timer
Timer Test, 2.3L Calif.
Fig. 43 - Timer Test
1. Remove timer.
2. Connect suitable test wires to timer terminals A, B and C respectively.
3. Connect a suitable test wire with a 30K ohm resistor to terminal D.
4. Connect a suitable test wire with a 3.4 watt lamp to terminal E.
5. Connect positive leads of a voltmeter to terminal D and negative test lead to battery negative
terminal.
6. Connect test wires from timer terminals A, D and E to battery positive terminal. Do not connect
test wire from terminal B at this time.
7. Connect wire from terminal C to battery negative terminal.
8. Voltmeter should not read 6 volts.
9. Connect test wire from timer terminal B with battery positive terminal. At the instant the
connection is made, the volt. meter should read less than
1 volt and lamp should illuminate. Maintain this connection for 125 ± 15 seconds. Voltmeter should
read 8 volts.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve >
Page 163
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Water Thermo Switch
Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L Calif.
1. Remove thermo switch.
2. Connect an ohmmeter across the switch terminals and place sensor end of switch in a water
filled container. Place a thermometer into water and
gradually heat water while observing thermometer.
3. Note temperature at which continuity exists between switch terminals. The specified temperature
is 131 ±4°F. Replace switch if temperature is not
within specifications.
Distributor Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L With Auto. Trans., Calif.
The procedure to test this switch is the same as the one described previously for the Water Thermo
Switch, 2.3L Calif. However, the specified temperature is 50 ±4°F or above.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE
Pump Pressure ....................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 2.8 - 3.6 psi
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes Engine Controls > System Information > System Diagnosis > Transmisson Codes
A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes - Engine Controls: Testing and Inspection Transmisson Codes
For Transmission related codes, proceed to Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Technical Service Bulletins High Altitude Driveability
Modifications
Article No. 82-11A-1O June 4, 1982
Subject: Modification Of Sea Level Calibrations For Altitude Applications
Light Trucks 1982 Courier - All Except 2.0L High Altitude Calibration
Applicable Model:
WARNING:
This Modification Is Authorized Only For The Listed Engines. Performing This Modification On
Other Engines Is Unauthorized And Could Create Liability Under Applicable Federal Or Local
Laws.
Customers who may have relocated and/or continually operate the subject vehicles in high
altitudes (above 4,000 ft. altitude) may have the following procedures performed to improve
performance:
1. Remove the air cleaner and duct assembly.
2. Remove the bolts attaching the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever.
3. Disconnect the fuel line and fuel return line at the carburetor.
4. Disconnect the leads for the slow fuel cut valve (throttle solenoid) and coasting richer
(deceleration valve) (2.3 litre only) at the quick disconnects. Also, disconnect the
carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line at the carburetor. Disconnect the hose connecting the
carburetor to the vacuum amplifier. Disconnect the vacuum hose for the purge control valve.
5. Disconnect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only). Then, disconnect the lead wire for the
automatic choke. Remove the servo diaphragm link for the throttle opener (2.0 litre only).
6. Using Tool T72J-9510, remove the carburetor attaching nuts from the intake manifold studs and
remove the carburetor.
7. Remove the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
8. Remove the plugs and main jets from the carburetor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 181
Figure 7
9. Install the high altitude jets indicated in the table (Figure 7.)
10. Install the plugs.
11. Install the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
12. Position the carburetor and a new gasket on the intake manifold and install the attaching nuts.
13. Connect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only).
14. Connect the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever and install the attaching bolts.
15. Connect the slow fuel cut valve, automatic choke, and coasting richer (2.3 litre only) leads at
the quick disconnect.
16. Connect the carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line. Connect the vacuum hose for the purge
control valve.
17. Connect the fuel line and fuel return line to the carburetor. Install the air cleaner and duct
assembly.
18. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
19. For 2.3 litre California Courier with manual transmission, adjust the dash pot as per "1981 Ford
Courier Truck Shop Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-05.
20. For 2.0 litre Courier, adjust the throttle positioner system as per "1981 Ford Courier Truck Shop
Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-06.
Install a Courier Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label (available at all Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealers) in a prominent place adjacent to the Vehicle Emission Control Information
Label. Do not install the label on any component that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
Clean the area before installing the label.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 182
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label for Low Altitude Adjustment:
This label is attached firmly to a readily visible position and beside to the existing vehicle emission
control information label,
Do not Install the label on any equipment that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label is a new label to be used for altitude
modifications.
Do not Use the Authorized Modifications label which is used to indicate other types of
modifications. If the vehicle is returned to continuous sea level (below 4,000 ft. alt.) operation, the
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label should be removed. Install the low altitude jets
and make the required adjustments.
WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual.
OPERATION/TIME: "Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual.
DLR. Coding:
Basic Part No. Code:
L05 53
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Bypass Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Air Injection Bypass Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect air hose at the check valve.
2. Open the choke and start and run engine at 1500 RPM. Air should flow from the hose.
3. Close choke. No air should flow from the hose at full choke. Replace bypass valve if air flow is
noted.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Check Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Air Injection Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 7 - Air Manifold Check Valve Test
1. Remove check valve from air injection manifold.
2. Blow through the intake side of the valve, then the outlet side, Fig. 7.
3. Air should pass through the valve from the intake side only. If air passes from the outlet side,
replace the check valve.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Control Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Air Injection Control Valve: Testing and Inspection
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Fig. 8b - Air Control Valve Test
Fig. 8c - Air Control Valve Test
1. Disconnect air hose at bottom of air control valve, Figs. 8B and 8C. 2. Start and run engine at
idle speed.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Control Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 194
3. Air should not be discharged from air control valve outlet port. 4. Disconnect intake manifold
vacuum line from top of air control valve. Air should now be discharged from the outlet port. 5. If
valve does not operate properly, replace air control valve, if necessary.
1977-79 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
Fig. 8D - Air Control Valve Test
1. Disconnect air hose from bottom of air control valve, Fig. 8D. 2. Start and run engine at idle
speed. 3. Disconnect vacuum line from air bypass valve. Air should be discharged from air control
valve outlet port. 4. Plug the disconnected air bypass valve vacuum line. No air should be
discharged from the outlet port.
Fig. 9 - Air Control Valve Test
5. Disconnect intake manifold vacuum line from the No. 2 relief valve. Remove plug from
disconnect air bypass valve vacuum line and connect line
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Control Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 195
to the No. 2 relief valve, Fig. 9. Air should be discharged from the air control valve outlet port.
6. If valve does not operate properly, check vacuum lines and replace air control valve, if
necessary.
1980-82 MANUAL TRANSMISSION
Fig. 9A - Air Control Valve Test
Fig. 9B - Air Control Valve Test
1. Start engine and bring to normal operating temperature. 2. Shut engine off, and disconnect air
hose from bottom of air control valve, Figs. 9A and 9B. 3. Start engine and run at idle speed. 4.
Disconnect vacuum control line from No. 1 relief valve of air control valve. Observe outlet port of air
control valve. Air should be discharged. 5. Reconnect vacuum control line to No. 1 relief valve of air
control valve. Observe outlet port of air control valve. Air should not be discharged. 6. Disconnect
vacuum control line from No. 2 relief valve of air control valve. 7. Disconnect vacuum line from air
bypass valve on 2.3 Liter engines, or from the EVAP shutter valve on 2.0 Liter engines. Reconnect
this line to the
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Control Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 196
No. 2 relief valve of the air control valve. Observe outlet port of air control valve. Air should be
discharged.
8. Disconnect vacuum control line from No. 2 relief valve of air control valve. Connect this line to
the air bypass valve on 2.3 Liter engines, or to the
EVAP shutter valve on 2.0 Liter engines. Observe outlet port of air control valve. Air should not be
discharged.
9. If valve does not operate properly, check vacuum lines, and replace air control valve if required.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Air Injection Pump: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect air pump outlet hose from bypass valve or air control valve.
Fig. 5 - Air Pump Test
2. Connect a tee fitting in the outlet hose and connect a pressure gauge to the tee fitting. Also,
insert a plug with a 11/32 inch hole in the remaining port of the tee fitting, Fig. 5.
3. Start and run engine at 1250-1500 RPM. Ensure the choke is fully open.
4. Check pressure reading. If below 1 psi, replace the air pump.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Relief Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Air Injection Relief Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 6 - Air Pump Relief Valve Test
1. With engine operating at idle speed, check relief valve for air flow, Fig. 6. If air flow is noted,
replace the relief valve and air pump assembly.
2. Increase engine speed to 3000 RPM on 1972-77 and 4500 on 1978-82. If air flows from the
valve, the valve is satisfactory. If air does not flow
from the valve or if the valve is excessively noisy, replace the relief valve and air pump assembly.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Some 1976-82 vehicles use a catalytic converter to reduce hydrocarbon and carbon monoxide
exhaust emission levels. These vehicles are also equipped with a catalyst warning system. This
system is comprised of a thermo sensor on the catalytic converter, monitoring converter
temperature, and a warning lamp on the instrument panel which illuminates when the thermo
sensor detects converter temperatures over 1742°F.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 206
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
Warning System Test
1. Turn ignition switch to "On" position. The warning lamp should illuminate, indicating that the bulb
and electrical wiring are satisfactory. If lamp
does not light, check bulb.
2. Start engine and if the system is satisfactory, the warning lamp should go out. If not, stop engine
and tilt the seatback forward.
Fig. 31 - Catalyst Warning System Test
3. Disconnect the catalytic converter thermo sensor electrical connectors, Fig. 31.
4. With an ohmmeter, check the circuit on the thermo sensor side of the wiring for continuity, Fig.
31. Replace the thermo sensor if the reading
indicates no continuity.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger
This valve prevents afterburning in the exhaust system during deceleration. At the start of sudden
deceleration, a rich air-fuel mixture is present in the intake manifold and is supplied to each
cylinder. This rich fuel mixture does not burn completely during normal combustion and is
discharged into the exhaust system. The air supplied from the air pump to the exhaust port dilutes
the unburned rich mixture to a combustible mixture, causing abnormal burning or afterburning in
the exhaust system. To prevent this, the air bypass valve senses the high intake manifold vacuum
and diverts the air. On 1977-78 models, this air is diverted into the air pump inlet. On 1979-82
models, most of the air is diverted to the air pump inlet while some of it is diverted to the intake
manifold.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 211
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation Anti-Afterburn Valve
Fig. 14 - Anti-Afterburn Valve
The anti-afterburn valve, Fig. 14, is controlled and operated by intake manifold vacuum. The valve
is activated when intake manifold vacuum suddenly increases and is kept open in proportion to the
amount of pressure change sensed by the diaphragm of the valve system. The diaphragm is
installed with the check valve and the metering orifice. The check valve permits air flow only from
the vacuum sensing chamber to the air chamber. Therefore, if the air in the vacuum sensing tube
decreases, the check valve opens and allows air flow into the air chamber to equalize the vacuum
of both chambers. If the vacuum increases, the check valve closes and the diaphragm moves
downward until the air flow through the metering orifice equalizes the vacuum. When the
diaphragm is pushed downward, the air valve opens to allow air flow to the intake manifold.
However, as the pressure is equalized, the spring returns the diaphragm and air valve to the closed
position. The time required to equalize the vacuum is in proportion to the amount of vacuum
change applied to the diaphragm.
As the anti-afterburn valve completes its operation, the deceleration valve adds additional fuel to
enrichen the lean mixture created in the intake manifold by the deceleration action. This additional
fuel permits more complete combustion and reduced emission contaminants.
The deceleration valve operates when all its controlling switches are closed. The accelerator switch
closes the circuit when the accelerator pedal is released. The speedometer switch closes the circuit
at speeds above 17-23 mph. On 1972-74 models, the clutch switch closes the circuit when the
clutch pedal is released.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 212
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation Coasting Valve
This valve adds additional fuel to the lean air fuel mixture caused by deceleration. This additional
fuel insures more complete combustion and reduces exhaust emissions.
This valve is controlled by two switches; the speedometer switch and accelerator switch. Both of
these switches must be closed in order for the coasting richer valve to function. The accelerator
switch closed the coasting richer circuit whenever the accelerator pedal is in the released position.
Depressing the accelerator pedal opens the circuit. The speedometer switch completes the circuit
at speeds above 17 to 23 mph.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 213
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation Dashpot
The dashpot prevents instant throttle closure when the accelerator pedal is released for slowing
down or shifting the transmission.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 214
Deceleration Valve: Description and Operation
Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger
This valve prevents afterburning in the exhaust system during deceleration. At the start of sudden
deceleration, a rich air-fuel mixture is present in the intake manifold and is supplied to each
cylinder. This rich fuel mixture does not burn completely during normal combustion and is
discharged into the exhaust system. The air supplied from the air pump to the exhaust port dilutes
the unburned rich mixture to a combustible mixture, causing abnormal burning or afterburning in
the exhaust system. To prevent this, the air bypass valve senses the high intake manifold vacuum
and diverts the air. On 1977-78 models, this air is diverted into the air pump inlet. On 1979-82
models, most of the air is diverted to the air pump inlet while some of it is diverted to the intake
manifold.
Anti-Afterburn Valve
Fig. 14 - Anti-Afterburn Valve
The anti-afterburn valve, Fig. 14, is controlled and operated by intake manifold vacuum. The valve
is activated when intake manifold vacuum suddenly increases and is kept open in proportion to the
amount of pressure change sensed by the diaphragm of the valve system. The diaphragm is
installed with the check valve and the metering orifice. The check valve permits air flow only from
the vacuum sensing chamber to the air chamber. Therefore, if the air in the vacuum sensing tube
decreases, the check valve opens and allows air flow into the air chamber to equalize the vacuum
of both chambers. If the vacuum increases, the check valve closes and the diaphragm moves
downward until the air flow through the metering orifice equalizes the vacuum. When the
diaphragm is pushed downward, the air valve opens to allow air flow to the intake manifold.
However, as the pressure is equalized, the spring returns the diaphragm and air valve to the closed
position. The time required to equalize the vacuum is in proportion to the amount of vacuum
change applied to the diaphragm.
As the anti-afterburn valve completes its operation, the deceleration valve adds additional fuel to
enrichen the lean mixture created in the intake manifold by the deceleration action. This additional
fuel permits more complete combustion and reduced emission contaminants.
The deceleration valve operates when all its controlling switches are closed. The accelerator switch
closes the circuit when the accelerator pedal is released. The speedometer switch closes the circuit
at speeds above 17-23 mph. On 1972-74 models, the clutch switch closes the circuit when the
clutch pedal is released.
Coasting Valve
This valve adds additional fuel to the lean air fuel mixture caused by deceleration. This additional
fuel insures more complete combustion and reduces exhaust emissions.
This valve is controlled by two switches; the speedometer switch and accelerator switch. Both of
these switches must be closed in order for the coasting richer valve to function. The accelerator
switch closed the coasting richer circuit whenever the accelerator pedal is in the released position.
Depressing the accelerator pedal opens the circuit. The speedometer switch completes the circuit
at speeds above 17 to 23 mph.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 215
Dashpot
The dashpot prevents instant throttle closure when the accelerator pedal is released for slowing
down or shifting the transmission.
System Description
1972 Exc. California
The deceleration control system on these models is a three part system. One part controls throttle
opening during deceleration, another part acts to retard spark during deceleration and a third part
retards the spark during engine idle.
A vacuum control valve is the component which controls both the spark retard and the throttle
opening during deceleration. The vacuum control valve senses the higher Intake manifold vacuum
and activates both systems. The throttle opening system uses a servo diaphragm assembly
connected to the primary throttle shaft. During deceleration, the vacuum control valve opens to
allow vacuum to be applied to the servo diaphragm. The diaphragm then moves to open the
primary throttle plate slightly and feeds additional fuel to richen the mixture.
The spark retard system uses a dual point distributor and a vacuum switch. During deceleration,
the vacuum control valve opens to allow vacuum to be applied to the vacuum switch. The vacuum
switch then closes and activates the retard breaker points in the distributor to retard the spark.
During acceleration and normal operation, the spark is controlled by the standard breaker point set.
During deceleration, the standard breaker points are by-passed and the spark is controlled by the
retard set. This retard circuit retards spark advance 7-10 degrees, decreasing engine speed.
During engine idle, the accelerator switch controls the retard points in the distributor. When the
engine is running above idle, the accelerator switch is open and the distributor operates on the
standard breaker point set. When the accelerator pedal is released, the switch is closed and the
retard breaker point set is activated, retarding spark advance.
1972 California & 1973-82
This system maintains a balanced air fuel mixture during deceleration.
Fig. 13 - Deceleration Control System
This system on 1972 California and 1973-76 engines consists of an air control valve, anti-afterburn
valve and a coasting richer valve, Fig. 13.
This system on 1977-78 1.8 liter engines except California, consists of an anti-afterburn valve,
dashpot and a throttle opener system that is composed of a servo diaphragm connected to the
throttle lever and a vacuum control valve.
This system on 1977-78 1.8 liter California engines consist of an anti-afterburn valve and a throttle
position system composed of a servo
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Bypass Valve, Turbocharger > Page 216
diaphragm connected to the throttle lever and a vacuum control valve.
This system on 1977-78 2.3 liter engines except California, consist of an air bypass valve, a
dashpot on manual transmission equipped models, and a coasting richer valve which is actuated
by vehicle speed and the accelerator switch.
This system on 1977 2.3 liter California engines consists of an air bypass valve and a dashpot on
manual transmission equipped vehicles.
This system on 1977-82 2.3 liter California engines consists of an air bypass valve, a dashpot on
manual transmission equipped vehicles and a coasting richer solenoid valve which is actuated by
vehicle speed and an accelerator switch.
This system on 1979-82 2.0 liter engines except California consist of an anti-afterburn valve and a
throttle positioner.
This system on 1979-81 2.0 liter California engines, consist of an air bypass valve and throttle
positioner.
Throttle Opener
Throttle Opener System, 1976
California vehicles equipped with manual transmission are equipped with this system to protect the
catalytic converter from abnormally high temperatures by maintaining an optimum air-fuel mixture
to the engine during deceleration. This system incorporated a servo diaphragm and throttle lever
which opens the primary throttle valve in the carburetor. A vacuum control valve issued to detect
intake manifold vacuum and actuates the servo diaphragm during deceleration.
Throttle Opener System, 1977-82
This system opens the primary throttle valve slightly so that an optimum amount of air-fuel mixture
is fed to the engine to reduce emissions during deceleration, since during deceleration, the air-fuel
mixture entering the engine is not sufficient for complete combustion.
This system consists of a servo diaphragm connected to a throttle lever, a three way solenoid valve
which controls intake manifold vacuum to the servo diaphragm and an engine speed switch which
grounds the throttle positioner circuit.
When engine speed is above 1700 RPM, the engine speed switch opens the throttle positioner
circuit and the three way solenoid valve allows intake manifold vacuum to actuate the servo
diaphragm and increase engine speed.
When engine speed is less than 1700 RPM, the engine speed switch grounds the throttle
positioner circuit. The three way solenoid valve prevents vacuum from applying the servo
diaphragm.
On 1979-82 models with air conditioning, when the air conditioning is turned on, the air conditioning
relay opens the throttle positioner circuit regardless of the position of the engine speed switch. With
the three way solenoid valve energized, vacuum is applied to the servo diaphragm to increase
engine speed.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Anti-Afterburn Valve
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Anti-Afterburn Valve
1. Disconnect inlet hose from anti-afterburn valve.
Fig. 23 - Anti-afterburn Valve Test
2. With engine idling, lightly hold finger over inlet hose opening, Fig. 23. This should not cause the
engine speed to vary.
3. With finger lightly placed over inlet hose opening, increase engine speed and quickly release
accelerator. Air should flow inward for 3 seconds. If
air flows inward longer than 3 seconds, or if air does not flow inward at all, replace valve.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Anti-Afterburn Valve > Page 219
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Servo Diaphragm
1. Disconnect the vacuum control valve intake manifold vacuum sensing hose from tee fitting near
the air control valve.
2. Disconnect vacuum line from vacuum control valve and connect line to tee fitting so intake
manifold vacuum can be applied directly to the servo
diaphragm.
3. Disconnect vacuum hose from distributor vacuum advance unit.
Fig. 28 - Deceleration Valve Test
4. Start engine. The engine speed should rise to 1300-1500 RPM. If engine speed is not within
specifications, adjust by turning adjusting screw on
servo diaphragm throttle lever, Fig. 28.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Anti-Afterburn Valve > Page 220
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Three-Way Solenoid Valve
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Disconnect wire at three way solenoid valve.
3. The engine speed should increase to 1000 RPM on except California models, and 1100 RPM for
California models. If speed does not increase, the
three way solenoid valve or the servo diaphragm is not operating properly.
4. To adjust servo diaphragm:
a. Inspect throttle positioner vacuum hoses for cracks or hardening. Replace as required.
b. Start engine and set idle speed to specifications.
c. Turn engine off and disconnect vacuum hose from distributor and plug hose.
d. Disconnect vacuum line at vacuum amplifier and vacuum hose at three way solenoid valve.
Connect vacuum hose from servo diaphragm to
vacuum amplifier so intake manifold vacuum is applied directly to servo diaphragm.
e. Connect a tachometer to engine and start engine. Engine speed should increase to 1000 ±100
RPM on all except California, and 1100 ±100 on
California models. If not, adjust engine speed by turning adjusting screw on servo diaphragm
throttle lever until proper engine speed is obtained.
f. Reconnect all vacuum hoses to their original positions.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Anti-Afterburn Valve > Page 221
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Vacuum Control Valve
Fig. 29 - Vacuum Control Valve Test
1. Disconnect and plug intake manifold vacuum hose from anti-afterburn valve at the tee fitting.
Connect a vacuum gauge to the tee fitting, Fig. 29.
2. Start engine and raise speed to 3000 RPM, then release accelerator and observe vacuum
gauge. The vacuum reading should drop to 22.4 inch Hg.
momentarily before dropping to the normal idle vacuum reading.
3. If the vacuum reading is not within specifications, loosen locking screw and rotate adjusting
screw on vacuum control valve until the proper
reading is obtained.
NOTE: The vacuum level at which the vacuum control valve operates was set at an atmospheric
pressure of 22.9 inch Hg. If the atmospheric pressure at time of testing is different than 22.9 inch
Hg., change the desired reading by adding or subtracting the amount equivalent to the difference
between 22.9 inch Hg. and the actual atmospheric reading.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Deceleration Valve > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Anti-Afterburn Valve > Page 222
Deceleration Valve: Testing and Inspection Water Thermo Valve
1. Remove thermo valve.
2. Place thermo valve in a container of water with a thermometer.
3. Gradually heat water while observing temperature.
4. Apply air pressure to thermo valve. Air should flow when valve opens at 115°F.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Early Fuel Evaporation ( EFE ) > EFE
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
EFE Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 36 - Evaporation Shutter Valve Test
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Remove air cleaner element.
3. Check to make sure that shutter valve is completely open.
4. Check to make sure that shutter valve closes completely when disconnecting vacuum sensing
tube from vacuum diaphragm.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Canister Purge Control Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 35 - Testing Purge Control Valve
1. Disconnect vacuum sensing tubes from water thermo valve and from intake manifold at purge
control valve.
2. Plug vacuum sensing tube to intake manifold.
3. Start engine and operate at idle.
4. Connect a hose to inlet port "b" of valve and lightly apply air pressure to valve. No air should flow
through valve.
5. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from intake manifold and connect tube to water thermo port "a"
of purge control valve. Again, lightly apply air
pressure to port "b." Air should pass through valve.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Locations
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Thermal Vacuum Valve - EVAP > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Thermal Vacuum Valve - EVAP: Testing and Inspection
Water Thermo Valve, Exc. Calif. 2.3L
1. Remove valve.
2. Connect hoses to inlet and outlet ports of valve and submerge valve in a water filled container.
3. Place a thermometer in water and gradually heat water while applying air pressure to valve.
4. Air should flow through valve when water temperature reaches 131°F, or above on all except
California with 2.3L engine, or 110°F, or above on
California models with 2.3L engine.
Water Thermo Valve, Calif. 2.3L
1. Remove switch.
2. Place sensor portion of switch in water, and slowly heat water.
3. Attach ohmmeter to switch terminals, and observe temperature at which continuity exists.
Specification requires continuity to occur at 131 ±4°F. If
not within this range, switch is defective.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > EGR Solenoids - Contamination
EGR Control Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins EGR Solenoids - Contamination
Article No. 85-13-5
EGR SOLENOIDS - CONTAMINATION
FORD 1980-1985 ALL WITH ELECTRONIC EGR CONTROL AND VENT SOLENOIDS
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1980-1985 ALL WITH ELECTRONIC EGR CONTROL AND VENT
SOLENOIDS
The use of starter fluids (ether and xylene), choke and/or fuel injector cleaners, can contaminate
the EGR control and vent solenoids EGRC/EGRY. These solvents may affect the upper elastomer
tip of the solenoid armature, causing an inoperative condition.
Care must also be used to avoid getting these starter fluids into the vacuum harness, and
contaminating these emission components in this way.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 242
EGR Control Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Three-way Solenoid Valve Test
1. Disconnect electrical connecters from water thermo switch and connect a jumper wire between
the connectors.
2. Turn ignition switch to "On" position.
3. Disconnect vacuum hose from EGR valve and blow into the hose, Fig. 12. Check for air
discharge at the three-way solenoid valve relief port. If air
does not discharge, replace the three-way solenoid valve.
4. Turn ignition switch to "Off" position.
Fig. 12 - EGR Three-Way Solenoid Valve Test
5. Remove jumper wire from the water thermo switch connectors and disconnect vacuum amplifier
vacuum line from the three-way solenoid valve,
Fig. 12.
6. Turn ignition switch to "On" position.
7. Blow into EGR valve hose. Check for air discharge at the vacuum amplifier port of the three-way
control valve. If air does not discharge, replace
the three-way solenoid valve.
8. If valve tests satisfactory, reconnect all vacuum hoses and electrical connections in original
positions.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > EGR Solenoids Contamination
EGR Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins EGR Solenoids Contamination
Article No. 85-13-5
EGR SOLENOIDS - CONTAMINATION
FORD 1980-1985 ALL WITH ELECTRONIC EGR CONTROL AND VENT SOLENOIDS
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1980-1985 ALL WITH ELECTRONIC EGR CONTROL AND VENT
SOLENOIDS
The use of starter fluids (ether and xylene), choke and/or fuel injector cleaners, can contaminate
the EGR control and vent solenoids EGRC/EGRY. These solvents may affect the upper elastomer
tip of the solenoid armature, causing an inoperative condition.
Care must also be used to avoid getting these starter fluids into the vacuum harness, and
contaminating these emission components in this way.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Maintenance Light > Component Information > Service and Repair
EGR Maintenance Light: Service and Repair
EGR Warning Switch Reset
NOTE:
After performing the necessary EGR system maintenance, the EGR warning lamp switch can be
reset. The switch is installed behind the speedometer and is reset as follows:
Procedure
1. Remove cover from switch.
2. Slide the switch knob to the opposite position and the warning lamp will go out.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
EGR Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Run engine at idle speed and disconnect vacuum hose from EGR valve.
2. Disconnect intake manifold vacuum line from vacuum amplifier and connect to EGR valve. The
engine should then stall or idle roughly. If not,
stop engine and remove the EGR valve.
3. Clean passages of EGR valve and pipe with a brush and a wire.
4. Install EGR valve and repeat test. If engine still does not stall or run roughly, replace the EGR
valve and repeat test.
5. If test is satisfactory, reconnect vacuum lines to original positions.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Thermal
Vacuum Valve, EGR > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Thermal Vacuum Valve: Testing and Inspection
81-82 2.3L California
1. Remove thermo switch.
2. Connect an ohmmeter across switch terminals and place sensor end of switch in a water filled
container. Place a thermometer into water and
gradually heat water while observing thermometer.
3. Note temperature at which continuity exists between switch terminals. The specified temperature
is 122 ±4° F or above. If temperature is not
within specifications, replace switch.
79-82 Exc. 81-82 2.3L California
1. Remove thermo valve.
2. Place valve in a water filled container. Place a thermometer into water and gradually heat water
while observing thermometer.
3. Apply air pressure to valve. Air should flow indicating that valve is open when water temperature
reaches 115°F on 1979-80, 122°F for 1981-82
2.0L engines, and 131°F for 1981-82 2.3L engines.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Vacuum
Amplifier, EGR > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Vacuum Amplifier: Testing and Inspection
1. Start engine and allow to reach normal operating temperature.
2. On 1976-78, disconnect vacuum amplifier vacuum hose from three-way solenoid valve and
connect a vacuum gauge to hose.
3. On 1979-80 and 1981 except California, disconnect vacuum amplifier vacuum hose from water
thermo valve and connect a vacuum gauge to hose.
4. On 1981 California, disconnect vacuum amplifier hose from EGR control valve and connect a
vacuum gauge to hose.
5. Disconnect vacuum amplifier hose from carburetor.
6. Depress accelerator several times and allow engine to return to idle. The vacuum gauge should
indicate 2 ± .04 inches Hg vacuum.
7. Reconnect vacuum amplifier hose to carburetor and increase engine speed to 3500 RPM. The
vacuum gauge should now indicate 3.54 inches Hg
vacuum. If not, replace vacuum amplifier.
8. Reconnect all vacuum hoses to original positions.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Positive Crankcase Ventilation: Description and Operation
Description
This system diverts blow-by gases into the intake manifold to be burned by the engine. The system
consists of a positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve, an oil separator and the hoses needed to
connect these components.
Operation
Fig. 1 - PCV Valve Operation
Ventilating air is routed into the rocker cover from the air cleaner, then through the oil separator
and to the PCV valve. The PCV valve is operated by the difference in pressure between the intake
manifold and the rocker cover. When there is no difference in pressure or the pressure of the intake
manifold is greater than the rocker cover, the PCV valve is pulled toward the rocker cover by the
tension of the valve spring, Fig. 1. If there is a large difference in pressure, the high vacuum of the
intake manifold overcomes the tension of the valve spring and the valve is pulled toward the intake
manifold side by the manifold vacuum, Fig. 1. The air then passes through the restricted passage
in the valve. If the difference in pressure is small, the valve is balanced by the tension of the valve
spring and intake manifold vacuum, Fig. 1. This valve position increases the flow of ventilating air.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 262
Positive Crankcase Ventilation: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove hose from PCV valve.
2. Start and run engine at 700-1000 RPM.
3. Hold a finger over end of PCV valve. A distinct vacuum should be felt. If not, replace PCV valve.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE
Pump Pressure ....................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 2.8 - 3.6 psi
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Carburetor > Carburetor Jet >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Carburetor Jet: Technical Service Bulletins High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Article No. 82-11A-1O June 4, 1982
Subject: Modification Of Sea Level Calibrations For Altitude Applications
Light Trucks 1982 Courier - All Except 2.0L High Altitude Calibration
Applicable Model:
WARNING:
This Modification Is Authorized Only For The Listed Engines. Performing This Modification On
Other Engines Is Unauthorized And Could Create Liability Under Applicable Federal Or Local
Laws.
Customers who may have relocated and/or continually operate the subject vehicles in high
altitudes (above 4,000 ft. altitude) may have the following procedures performed to improve
performance:
1. Remove the air cleaner and duct assembly.
2. Remove the bolts attaching the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever.
3. Disconnect the fuel line and fuel return line at the carburetor.
4. Disconnect the leads for the slow fuel cut valve (throttle solenoid) and coasting richer
(deceleration valve) (2.3 litre only) at the quick disconnects. Also, disconnect the
carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line at the carburetor. Disconnect the hose connecting the
carburetor to the vacuum amplifier. Disconnect the vacuum hose for the purge control valve.
5. Disconnect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only). Then, disconnect the lead wire for the
automatic choke. Remove the servo diaphragm link for the throttle opener (2.0 litre only).
6. Using Tool T72J-9510, remove the carburetor attaching nuts from the intake manifold studs and
remove the carburetor.
7. Remove the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
8. Remove the plugs and main jets from the carburetor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Carburetor > Carburetor Jet >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 272
Figure 7
9. Install the high altitude jets indicated in the table (Figure 7.)
10. Install the plugs.
11. Install the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
12. Position the carburetor and a new gasket on the intake manifold and install the attaching nuts.
13. Connect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only).
14. Connect the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever and install the attaching bolts.
15. Connect the slow fuel cut valve, automatic choke, and coasting richer (2.3 litre only) leads at
the quick disconnect.
16. Connect the carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line. Connect the vacuum hose for the purge
control valve.
17. Connect the fuel line and fuel return line to the carburetor. Install the air cleaner and duct
assembly.
18. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
19. For 2.3 litre California Courier with manual transmission, adjust the dash pot as per "1981 Ford
Courier Truck Shop Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-05.
20. For 2.0 litre Courier, adjust the throttle positioner system as per "1981 Ford Courier Truck Shop
Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-06.
Install a Courier Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label (available at all Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealers) in a prominent place adjacent to the Vehicle Emission Control Information
Label. Do not install the label on any component that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
Clean the area before installing the label.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Carburetor > Carburetor Jet >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 273
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label for Low Altitude Adjustment:
This label is attached firmly to a readily visible position and beside to the existing vehicle emission
control information label,
Do not Install the label on any equipment that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label is a new label to be used for altitude
modifications.
Do not Use the Authorized Modifications label which is used to indicate other types of
modifications. If the vehicle is returned to continuous sea level (below 4,000 ft. alt.) operation, the
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label should be removed. Install the low altitude jets
and make the required adjustments.
WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual.
OPERATION/TIME: "Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual.
DLR. Coding:
Basic Part No. Code:
L05 53
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Carburetor > Choke Housing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electric Choke System - Testing Tool
Choke Housing: Technical Service Bulletins Electric Choke System - Testing Tool
Article No: 82-10-13 May 24, 1982
Subject: Rotunda Choke Cap Tester No. 90-0001
FORD All Vehicles With Single - And Two-stage Electric Chokes
LINCOLN-MERCURY All Vehicles With Single - And Two-stage Electric Chokes
The tool was recently released to improve performance and reduce diagnosis time when servicing
choke systems.
Testing time has been reduced to a few minutes with the all electric two-stage choke system. The
temperature range of the tester is from -1 °F to 165 °F. For optimum tool performance, shop air
with a line pressure of 90 PSI with 6-8 C.F.M. volume is required.
An adaptor is provided to service older model single-stage and hot-air-only systems. The unit is
also recommended for testing other heat sensitive/actuated components and auto/temp control
systems.
Refer to the Engine/Emission/Diagnosis Manual and the Manufacturers Instruction Manual
(provided) for procedures and instructions.
Warranty Status: Information Only
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Carburetor > Choke
Thermostat/Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Alternator - Replacement Precautions
Choke Thermostat/Heater: Technical Service Bulletins Alternator - Replacement Precautions
Article No. 85-12-24
RICH MIXTURE - CHOKE DOES NOT OPEN - ELECTRIC CHOKE CONNECTION TO NON-OEM
ALTERNATOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL SERIES
Replacement of the OEM alternator to accomodate higher current requirements of vehicle-mounted
electrical equipment may adversely affect the operation of the electric choke on those vehicles so
equipped. For this reason, it is important to examine the electrical system on a subject vehicle to
determine if an electric choke is connected to the OEM alternator stator terminal. If there is such a
connection, a similar connection must be provided on the replacement alternator.
Contact the manufacturer of the replacement alternator to determine the correct method of
connecting to the alternator stator.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Dashpot > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Dashpot: Technical Service Bulletins High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Article No. 82-11A-1O June 4, 1982
Subject: Modification Of Sea Level Calibrations For Altitude Applications
Light Trucks 1982 Courier - All Except 2.0L High Altitude Calibration
Applicable Model:
WARNING:
This Modification Is Authorized Only For The Listed Engines. Performing This Modification On
Other Engines Is Unauthorized And Could Create Liability Under Applicable Federal Or Local
Laws.
Customers who may have relocated and/or continually operate the subject vehicles in high
altitudes (above 4,000 ft. altitude) may have the following procedures performed to improve
performance:
1. Remove the air cleaner and duct assembly.
2. Remove the bolts attaching the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever.
3. Disconnect the fuel line and fuel return line at the carburetor.
4. Disconnect the leads for the slow fuel cut valve (throttle solenoid) and coasting richer
(deceleration valve) (2.3 litre only) at the quick disconnects. Also, disconnect the
carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line at the carburetor. Disconnect the hose connecting the
carburetor to the vacuum amplifier. Disconnect the vacuum hose for the purge control valve.
5. Disconnect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only). Then, disconnect the lead wire for the
automatic choke. Remove the servo diaphragm link for the throttle opener (2.0 litre only).
6. Using Tool T72J-9510, remove the carburetor attaching nuts from the intake manifold studs and
remove the carburetor.
7. Remove the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
8. Remove the plugs and main jets from the carburetor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Dashpot > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 286
Figure 7
9. Install the high altitude jets indicated in the table (Figure 7.)
10. Install the plugs.
11. Install the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
12. Position the carburetor and a new gasket on the intake manifold and install the attaching nuts.
13. Connect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only).
14. Connect the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever and install the attaching bolts.
15. Connect the slow fuel cut valve, automatic choke, and coasting richer (2.3 litre only) leads at
the quick disconnect.
16. Connect the carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line. Connect the vacuum hose for the purge
control valve.
17. Connect the fuel line and fuel return line to the carburetor. Install the air cleaner and duct
assembly.
18. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
19. For 2.3 litre California Courier with manual transmission, adjust the dash pot as per "1981 Ford
Courier Truck Shop Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-05.
20. For 2.0 litre Courier, adjust the throttle positioner system as per "1981 Ford Courier Truck Shop
Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-06.
Install a Courier Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label (available at all Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealers) in a prominent place adjacent to the Vehicle Emission Control Information
Label. Do not install the label on any component that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
Clean the area before installing the label.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Dashpot > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 287
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label for Low Altitude Adjustment:
This label is attached firmly to a readily visible position and beside to the existing vehicle emission
control information label,
Do not Install the label on any equipment that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label is a new label to be used for altitude
modifications.
Do not Use the Authorized Modifications label which is used to indicate other types of
modifications. If the vehicle is returned to continuous sea level (below 4,000 ft. alt.) operation, the
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label should be removed. Install the low altitude jets
and make the required adjustments.
WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual.
OPERATION/TIME: "Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual.
DLR. Coding:
Basic Part No. Code:
L05 53
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Rotunda Gas Chek Kit - Requires Modification
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Rotunda Gas Chek Kit - Requires Modification
Article No. FUEL SYSTEM - ROTUNDA "GAS-CHEK" KIT 87-23-9 TOOL MODIFICATION
FORD: 1988 And Prior ALL CAR LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1988 And Prior ALL CAR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1988 And Prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: The Rotunda "Gas-Chek Kit" (Tool Number 113-00002) that you may have purchased prior
to October, 1987 requires modification. The necessary components and new operating instructions
will be shipped to you at no charge. This tool modification will provide greater accuracy when
performing high fuel vapor pressure testing of gasoline.
ACTION: To modify the Rotunda "Gas-Chek Kit", use the following service instructions.
NOTE: This modification MUST be done because it will seriously affect the volatility tests.
Figure 11
1. Remove adapter fitting attached to the 0-30 PSI gauge. CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN TO
PREVENT DAMAGE TO GAUGE ASSEMBLY WHEN REMOVING FITTING. Throw away the
adapter fitting, Figure 11.
2. Remove and throw away the aluminum vial, Figure 11.
3. Remove plastic thermos cup cap and throw away, Figure 11.
4. Remove the set of instructions from the lid of the Gas-Chek plastic storage box and throw them
away.
NOTE: USE ONLY THE NEW instruction booklet that is furnished in the modification kit.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Rotunda Gas Chek Kit - Requires Modification > Page 292
Figure 12
5. Using thread sealer or teflon tape on the threads of the PSI gauge, install gauge and tighten into
new cover and air chamber, Figure
12. After installation is made, this assembly should not be disassembled.
6. Position small, plastic gasoline sample container and gas cup holder into gauge and vial cavity
of die-cut, foam material for storage, Figure 12.
7. Care should be taken when storing unit to prevent damage which could then cause bad readings
when checking gasoline vapor pressure.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Hose Clamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Fuel Hose Clamp: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Filter - Replacement Information
Article No. 85-6-10
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT INFORMATION - ALL WITH FUEL FILTERS ATTACHED TO THE
CARBURETOR AND/OR FUEL LINE WITH A RUBBER HOSE
FORD ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
LIGHT TRUCK ALL 1985 AND PRIOR
New fuel connector hoses and clamps should be used whenever a fuel filter is replaced.
Due to possible deterioration of hose materials which may result if a vehicle is fueled with gasoline
containing excessive levels of methanol or ethanol, a new fuel hose and clamps should be installed
when the fuel filter is changed. DO NOT REUSE OLD HOSES OR CLAMPS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE
Pump Pressure ....................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 2.8 - 3.6 psi
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Component Information
> Service Precautions
Fuel Tank: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537° C (1000° F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Technical Service Bulletins High Altitude Driveability
Modifications
Article No. 82-11A-1O June 4, 1982
Subject: Modification Of Sea Level Calibrations For Altitude Applications
Light Trucks 1982 Courier - All Except 2.0L High Altitude Calibration
Applicable Model:
WARNING:
This Modification Is Authorized Only For The Listed Engines. Performing This Modification On
Other Engines Is Unauthorized And Could Create Liability Under Applicable Federal Or Local
Laws.
Customers who may have relocated and/or continually operate the subject vehicles in high
altitudes (above 4,000 ft. altitude) may have the following procedures performed to improve
performance:
1. Remove the air cleaner and duct assembly.
2. Remove the bolts attaching the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever.
3. Disconnect the fuel line and fuel return line at the carburetor.
4. Disconnect the leads for the slow fuel cut valve (throttle solenoid) and coasting richer
(deceleration valve) (2.3 litre only) at the quick disconnects. Also, disconnect the
carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line at the carburetor. Disconnect the hose connecting the
carburetor to the vacuum amplifier. Disconnect the vacuum hose for the purge control valve.
5. Disconnect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only). Then, disconnect the lead wire for the
automatic choke. Remove the servo diaphragm link for the throttle opener (2.0 litre only).
6. Using Tool T72J-9510, remove the carburetor attaching nuts from the intake manifold studs and
remove the carburetor.
7. Remove the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
8. Remove the plugs and main jets from the carburetor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 312
Figure 7
9. Install the high altitude jets indicated in the table (Figure 7.)
10. Install the plugs.
11. Install the locking plate (only for Courier 2.3 litre and Courier chassis cab).
12. Position the carburetor and a new gasket on the intake manifold and install the attaching nuts.
13. Connect the throttle return spring (2.3 litre only).
14. Connect the accelerator shaft to the throttle lever and install the attaching bolts.
15. Connect the slow fuel cut valve, automatic choke, and coasting richer (2.3 litre only) leads at
the quick disconnect.
16. Connect the carburetor-to-distributor vacuum line. Connect the vacuum hose for the purge
control valve.
17. Connect the fuel line and fuel return line to the carburetor. Install the air cleaner and duct
assembly.
18. Start the engine and check for fuel leaks.
19. For 2.3 litre California Courier with manual transmission, adjust the dash pot as per "1981 Ford
Courier Truck Shop Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-05.
20. For 2.0 litre Courier, adjust the throttle positioner system as per "1981 Ford Courier Truck Shop
Manual", Deceleration Control System, Section 29-03-06.
Install a Courier Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label (available at all Ford or
Lincoln-Mercury dealers) in a prominent place adjacent to the Vehicle Emission Control Information
Label. Do not install the label on any component that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
Clean the area before installing the label.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > High Altitude Driveability Modifications > Page 313
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label for Low Altitude Adjustment:
This label is attached firmly to a readily visible position and beside to the existing vehicle emission
control information label,
Do not Install the label on any equipment that can be easily detached from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label is a new label to be used for altitude
modifications.
Do not Use the Authorized Modifications label which is used to indicate other types of
modifications. If the vehicle is returned to continuous sea level (below 4,000 ft. alt.) operation, the
Vehicle Emission Control Information Update Label should be removed. Install the low altitude jets
and make the required adjustments.
WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual.
OPERATION/TIME: "Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual.
DLR. Coding:
Basic Part No. Code:
L05 53
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Throttle Cable/Linkage: > 83720 > Apr > 83 >
Accelerator Linkage - Raspy/Sticky
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Customer Interest Accelerator Linkage - Raspy/Sticky
Article No. 83-7-20
ACCELERATOR LINKAGE - DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
LIGHT TRUCKS 1980-83 LIGHT TRUCKS
Servicing of Cable-Type Acceleration Linkage
The following procedure will assist in diagnosing accelerator linkage concerns on 1980-83 light
trucks.
If the accelerator pedal, when operated, is hard to push down or feels "raspy" or "sticky", perform
the following:
1. First disconnect the accelerator cable from the carburetor (or injector pump) throttle lever ball
stud. Also disconnect the cruise control from the accelerator cable if so equipped.
2. Then check the following items:
^ Be sure that the disconnected end of the cable or its spring does not come into contact with any
of the surrounding parts.
^ Operate the pedal by foot.
^ If accelerator operation is smooth, the pedal assembly and cable are not the cause of the
concern. Refer to the carburetor/injector pump diagnosis procedures in the appropriate shop
manual for additional checks.
^ E, F, Bronco and Ranger with gas engine - See General Fuel System Service Section 24-01.
^ Ranger with Diesel Engine - See Ranger Shop Manual - 2.2L Diesel Engine Section 22-09 of the
Engine Performance Diagnostic Guide.
^ F Series with the 6.9L Diesel Engine - See the 1983 Car/Truck Shop Manual - Engine Electronics
Section 25-64.
^ If the concern persists (being sure disconnected end of cable has not come into contact with
anything), check foot pedal assembly for free operation. If pedal operation is free, replace the
cable.
If you have a high engine idle speed concern, check the following linkage systems:
1. First disconnect the accelerator cable from the carburetor (or injector pump) throttle lever ball
stud. Also disconnect the cruise control from the accelerator cable if so equipped.
^ If the cable ball socket extends beyond the throttle lever ball stud, refer to the carburetor
diagnosis procedures in the appropriate shop manual for the correct adjustment procedure. ^
If the socket does not extend beyond the stud, check the foot pedal assembly for free operation. If
the pedal operation is free, replace the cable.
NOTE: The accelerator cable should not be lubricated and it is not serviceable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION: M TIME:
"Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 9A758
Code: 41
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable/Linkage: > 83720 >
Apr > 83 > Accelerator Linkage - Raspy/Sticky
Throttle Cable/Linkage: All Technical Service Bulletins Accelerator Linkage - Raspy/Sticky
Article No. 83-7-20
ACCELERATOR LINKAGE - DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
LIGHT TRUCKS 1980-83 LIGHT TRUCKS
Servicing of Cable-Type Acceleration Linkage
The following procedure will assist in diagnosing accelerator linkage concerns on 1980-83 light
trucks.
If the accelerator pedal, when operated, is hard to push down or feels "raspy" or "sticky", perform
the following:
1. First disconnect the accelerator cable from the carburetor (or injector pump) throttle lever ball
stud. Also disconnect the cruise control from the accelerator cable if so equipped.
2. Then check the following items:
^ Be sure that the disconnected end of the cable or its spring does not come into contact with any
of the surrounding parts.
^ Operate the pedal by foot.
^ If accelerator operation is smooth, the pedal assembly and cable are not the cause of the
concern. Refer to the carburetor/injector pump diagnosis procedures in the appropriate shop
manual for additional checks.
^ E, F, Bronco and Ranger with gas engine - See General Fuel System Service Section 24-01.
^ Ranger with Diesel Engine - See Ranger Shop Manual - 2.2L Diesel Engine Section 22-09 of the
Engine Performance Diagnostic Guide.
^ F Series with the 6.9L Diesel Engine - See the 1983 Car/Truck Shop Manual - Engine Electronics
Section 25-64.
^ If the concern persists (being sure disconnected end of cable has not come into contact with
anything), check foot pedal assembly for free operation. If pedal operation is free, replace the
cable.
If you have a high engine idle speed concern, check the following linkage systems:
1. First disconnect the accelerator cable from the carburetor (or injector pump) throttle lever ball
stud. Also disconnect the cruise control from the accelerator cable if so equipped.
^ If the cable ball socket extends beyond the throttle lever ball stud, refer to the carburetor
diagnosis procedures in the appropriate shop manual for the correct adjustment procedure. ^
If the socket does not extend beyond the stud, check the foot pedal assembly for free operation. If
the pedal operation is free, replace the cable.
NOTE: The accelerator cable should not be lubricated and it is not serviceable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION: M TIME:
"Actual Time" as defined in the Warranty and Policy Manual. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 9A758
Code: 41
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition - Coil Durability/Radio Frequency Interference
Ignition Coil: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition - Coil Durability/Radio Frequency Interference
Article No. 84-22-8
IGNITION - COIL DURABILITY AND RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE
LIGHT TRUCKS 1985 AND PRIOR YEARS - ALL SERIES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCKS 1985 AND PRIOR YEARS - ALL SERIES
Relocation of the ignition coil to accomodate the installation of non-Ford engine-mounted
equipment may effect the durability of the coil and/or cause a radio frequency interference
condition. For these reasons movement of the ignition coil from its original location is not
recommended.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Control Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 - Spark Timing Control System
This system, Fig. 37, used on 1977-78 1.8 liter, 1979-82 2.0 liter and 1981-82 2.3 liter California
with manual transmission models reduces exhaust emissions by delaying vacuum to the distributor
vacuum advance unit during vehicle acceleration.
The system consists of a vacuum delay valve installed in the vacuum line between the carburetor
and distributor on 1.8 liter and 2.0 liter engines except California, or between the water thermo
valve and distributor on 2.0 liter California engines. On 2.3 liter engines, the system consists of a
spark delay valve (manual transmission equipped models) and a distributor solenoid valve installed
in the vacuum line between the intake manifold and distributor. The distributor solenoid valve is
controlled by a timer and water thermo switch (also a distributor water thermo switch on vehicles
with automatic transmission).
The spark delay valve has an internal restrictor to slow air flow in one direction and a check valve
which allows free air flow in the opposite direction.
On 1979-82 California models, distributor vacuum advance is restricted by the water thermo valve
which detects engine coolant temperature. This helps to warm up the catalytic converter.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Delay Valve
Spark Delay Valve, 1977-80, 1980-82 exc. Calif.
1. Remove air cleaner and disconnect vacuum line from distributor.
Fig. 38 - Spark Delay Valve Test
2. On 1977-78, disconnect vacuum control line at intake manifold fitting and install distributor
vacuum line to intake manifold fitting, Fig. 38.
Fig. 39 - Spark Delay Valve Test
Fig. 40 - Spark Delay Valve Test
3. On 1979-82, disconnect air bypass line on California models, Figs. 39 and 40, or air
anti-afterburn valve on except California models and connect
distributor vacuum line disconnected previously to intake manifold fitting.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 338
Fig. 41 - Spark Delay Valve Test
4. Remove vacuum line from carburetor side of vacuum delay valve, then plug in and connect a
vacuum gauge to vacuum delay valve, Figs. 39, 40
and 41.
5. Start engine and allow to idle.
6. Disconnect vacuum line from intake manifold fitting.
NOTE:The time required for vacuum reading to drop to 11.8 inches Hg. If amount of time is not
within 4-6 seconds, replace valve.
Spark Delay Valve, 1981-82 2.3L Calif, 1982 2.OL Calif.
Fig. 42 - Spark Delay Valve Test
1. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor solenoid and connect a
vacuum gauge to tube.
NOTE: On 1982 vehicles, add a 30mm vacuum reservoir between spark delay valve and vacuum
gauge.
2. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor vacuum advance unit and
connect tube to intake manifold.
3. Start engine and note vacuum reading at idle.
4. Disconnect tube from intake manifold and check time required for vacuum reading to drop
decrease by 11.8 inches Hg. vacuum. Time required
should be 5 ± 1 seconds.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 339
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Distributor Solenoid Valve
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Separate connector at distributor solenoid valve and apply battery voltage to the two terminals to
energize the solenoid.
3. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from distributor solenoid valve at distributor vacuum advance.
4. Disconnect battery power from solenoid. Solenoid is functioning properly if vacuum is drawn into
vacuum sensing tube when battery is
disconnected.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 340
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Control Timer
Timer Test, 2.3L Calif.
Fig. 43 - Timer Test
1. Remove timer.
2. Connect suitable test wires to timer terminals A, B and C respectively.
3. Connect a suitable test wire with a 30K ohm resistor to terminal D.
4. Connect a suitable test wire with a 3.4 watt lamp to terminal E.
5. Connect positive leads of a voltmeter to terminal D and negative test lead to battery negative
terminal.
6. Connect test wires from timer terminals A, D and E to battery positive terminal. Do not connect
test wire from terminal B at this time.
7. Connect wire from terminal C to battery negative terminal.
8. Voltmeter should not read 6 volts.
9. Connect test wire from timer terminal B with battery positive terminal. At the instant the
connection is made, the volt. meter should read less than
1 volt and lamp should illuminate. Maintain this connection for 125 ± 15 seconds. Voltmeter should
read 8 volts.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Spark
Control Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 341
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Water Thermo Switch
Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L Calif.
1. Remove thermo switch.
2. Connect an ohmmeter across the switch terminals and place sensor end of switch in a water
filled container. Place a thermometer into water and
gradually heat water while observing thermometer.
3. Note temperature at which continuity exists between switch terminals. The specified temperature
is 131 ±4°F. Replace switch if temperature is not
within specifications.
Distributor Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L With Auto. Trans., Calif.
The procedure to test this switch is the same as the one described previously for the Water Thermo
Switch, 2.3L Calif. However, the specified temperature is 50 ±4°F or above.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Spark Control Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 37 - Spark Timing Control System
This system, Fig. 37, used on 1977-78 1.8 liter, 1979-82 2.0 liter and 1981-82 2.3 liter California
with manual transmission models reduces exhaust emissions by delaying vacuum to the distributor
vacuum advance unit during vehicle acceleration.
The system consists of a vacuum delay valve installed in the vacuum line between the carburetor
and distributor on 1.8 liter and 2.0 liter engines except California, or between the water thermo
valve and distributor on 2.0 liter California engines. On 2.3 liter engines, the system consists of a
spark delay valve (manual transmission equipped models) and a distributor solenoid valve installed
in the vacuum line between the intake manifold and distributor. The distributor solenoid valve is
controlled by a timer and water thermo switch (also a distributor water thermo switch on vehicles
with automatic transmission).
The spark delay valve has an internal restrictor to slow air flow in one direction and a check valve
which allows free air flow in the opposite direction.
On 1979-82 California models, distributor vacuum advance is restricted by the water thermo valve
which detects engine coolant temperature. This helps to warm up the catalytic converter.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Delay Valve
Spark Delay Valve, 1977-80, 1980-82 exc. Calif.
1. Remove air cleaner and disconnect vacuum line from distributor.
Fig. 38 - Spark Delay Valve Test
2. On 1977-78, disconnect vacuum control line at intake manifold fitting and install distributor
vacuum line to intake manifold fitting, Fig. 38.
Fig. 39 - Spark Delay Valve Test
Fig. 40 - Spark Delay Valve Test
3. On 1979-82, disconnect air bypass line on California models, Figs. 39 and 40, or air
anti-afterburn valve on except California models and connect
distributor vacuum line disconnected previously to intake manifold fitting.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 347
Fig. 41 - Spark Delay Valve Test
4. Remove vacuum line from carburetor side of vacuum delay valve, then plug in and connect a
vacuum gauge to vacuum delay valve, Figs. 39, 40
and 41.
5. Start engine and allow to idle.
6. Disconnect vacuum line from intake manifold fitting.
NOTE:The time required for vacuum reading to drop to 11.8 inches Hg. If amount of time is not
within 4-6 seconds, replace valve.
Spark Delay Valve, 1981-82 2.3L Calif, 1982 2.OL Calif.
Fig. 42 - Spark Delay Valve Test
1. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor solenoid and connect a
vacuum gauge to tube.
NOTE: On 1982 vehicles, add a 30mm vacuum reservoir between spark delay valve and vacuum
gauge.
2. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from spark delay valve at distributor vacuum advance unit and
connect tube to intake manifold.
3. Start engine and note vacuum reading at idle.
4. Disconnect tube from intake manifold and check time required for vacuum reading to drop
decrease by 11.8 inches Hg. vacuum. Time required
should be 5 ± 1 seconds.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 348
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Distributor Solenoid Valve
1. Start engine and allow to idle.
2. Separate connector at distributor solenoid valve and apply battery voltage to the two terminals to
energize the solenoid.
3. Disconnect vacuum sensing tube from distributor solenoid valve at distributor vacuum advance.
4. Disconnect battery power from solenoid. Solenoid is functioning properly if vacuum is drawn into
vacuum sensing tube when battery is
disconnected.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 349
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Spark Control Timer
Timer Test, 2.3L Calif.
Fig. 43 - Timer Test
1. Remove timer.
2. Connect suitable test wires to timer terminals A, B and C respectively.
3. Connect a suitable test wire with a 30K ohm resistor to terminal D.
4. Connect a suitable test wire with a 3.4 watt lamp to terminal E.
5. Connect positive leads of a voltmeter to terminal D and negative test lead to battery negative
terminal.
6. Connect test wires from timer terminals A, D and E to battery positive terminal. Do not connect
test wire from terminal B at this time.
7. Connect wire from terminal C to battery negative terminal.
8. Voltmeter should not read 6 volts.
9. Connect test wire from timer terminal B with battery positive terminal. At the instant the
connection is made, the volt. meter should read less than
1 volt and lamp should illuminate. Maintain this connection for 125 ± 15 seconds. Voltmeter should
read 8 volts.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Control Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Spark Delay Valve > Page 350
Spark Control Relay: Testing and Inspection Water Thermo Switch
Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L Calif.
1. Remove thermo switch.
2. Connect an ohmmeter across the switch terminals and place sensor end of switch in a water
filled container. Place a thermometer into water and
gradually heat water while observing thermometer.
3. Note temperature at which continuity exists between switch terminals. The specified temperature
is 131 ±4°F. Replace switch if temperature is not
within specifications.
Distributor Water Thermo Switch, 2.3L With Auto. Trans., Calif.
The procedure to test this switch is the same as the one described previously for the Water Thermo
Switch, 2.3L Calif. However, the specified temperature is 50 ±4°F or above.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > System Information > System
Diagnosis
Transmission Control Systems: Testing and Inspection
For Transmission Control Systems Diagnosis, go to Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes - Trans and Drivetrain > System
Information > System Diagnosis
A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes - Trans and Drivetrain: Testing and Inspection
For Transmission related codes, proceed to Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Choosing the Right ATF
TRANSMISSION: ALL
BULLETIN: # 9002006
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid
DATE: Feb 1990
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
CHOOSING YOUR ATF
Different ATF's (Automatic Transmission Fluid) can have different frictional properties which can
produce different shift characteristics. You may have already experienced problems like lock-up
shudder, or squawks on shifts and have corrected them by changing the fluid. This alone tells, you
that friction material and fluids are critical in today's cars.
MEETING THE O.E.M. SPECIFICATIONS
The first thing to consider when choosing an ATF is "Does it meet the O.E.M. specification?" ATF's
wishing to be labeled as DEXRON II and/or MERCON must first meet the respective minimum
requirements. It's important to note that even though the specification for DEXRON II and
MERCON are currently very similar, THEY ARE NOT IDENTICAL. Also note, even fluids which
meet the same specification may not be identical. One fluid may just meet a specification and,
another may far surpass it. You should know what your fluids properties are! You can get that
information from your fluid supplier.
EVALUATING YOUR FLUID
Ask your supplier to prove (certify) that the fluid meets O.E.M. specifications (MERCON OR
DEXRON II). He will do that by supplying you with the license (certification) number issued to him
by the O.E.M.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF > Page 362
A DEXRON-II license number (sometimes referred to as a "D" number) will always start D-2. A
typical DEXRON license number can be seen in Figure 2.
MERCON license numbers will be six digits starting with M as shown in Figure 3..
TRY TO MEET SEVERAL SPECIFICATIONS!
DEXRON II and MERCON have different minimum specifications, so a product that meets BOTH
specifications may be better then those meeting only one spec. Meeting other specs, in addition to
the first two can be an added benefit. If a fluid is licensed as DEXRON II AND MERCON as well as
others like Allison C-4, or Caterpillar TO-2/TO-4, it means the fluid had to pass more tests and may
be a better fluid.
Lastly, demand that the license numbers be placed on all your invoices especially if you buy in
bulk. If your supplier is unwilling, it is very likely that they are supplying you an unlicensed fluid.
Licensed suppliers are required to supply the license numbers to their customers as part of their
agreement with the O.E.M.
OTHER THINGS TO CHECK
So now you've narrowed your choices down to a few suppliers that have O.E.M. license numbers.
How do you compare two fluids that meet the same O.E.M. Spec.? Ask your supplier to give you
the viscometrics on the fluid you buy.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF > Page 363
An excellent "bench mark of the overall quality of a fluid is its viscosity at -40 degrees. This is
measured in "centipoise" or "cPs". DEXRON II specification says viscosity will be no more then
50,000 cPs @ - 40 degrees. (Some poor fluids have tested at over 1,000,000 cPs) In general, the
lower the number, the better the fluid.
Keep in mind that as the number goes down the price of the fluid usually goes up. (You get what
you pay for) Most good fluids will average around 35,000 cPs. Hydrotreated (or Hydrocracked)
fluids average around 20,000 cPs or less. (Hydrotreating is a refining process done to the base oil
to clean out contaminants or impurities) Synthetic ATF's average 10,000 cPs or less, and some are
as low as 5000 cPs. Viscosity at -40 degrees is a function of the base stock from which the ATF is
made. A low number indicates a premium base oil OR an expensive refining process.
(Hydrotreating)
FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION:
Transmission Digest August '89 Page 91 December '89 Page 51
BULLETIN RECAP
^ Only use fluids with O.E.M. approvals.
^ Try to get a fluid that meets more than one spec (e.g DEXRON II AND MERCON)
^ Check the viscosity at -40 degrees. The lower the number the better.
^ Avoid bargain basement fluids with no license numbers.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > 951610 > Aug > 95 > A/T
- New Rotunda Fluid Changer Service Tip
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - New Rotunda Fluid Changer
Service Tip
Article No. 95-16-10
08/14/95
FLUID - NEW ROTUNDA FLUID CHANGER - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 1980 and after CROWN VICTORIA, ESCORT, MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1982-88 EXP
1984-94 TEMPO 1986 and after TAURUS 1988-93 FESTIVA 1989 and after PROBE 1994 and
after ASPIRE 1995 and after CONTOUR
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980 and after CONTINENTAL, COUGAR, GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN
CAR 1981-87 LYNX 1984-92 MARK VII 1984-94 TOPAZ 1986 and after SABLE 1987-89 TRACER
1991-94 CAPRI 1991 and after TRACER 1993 and after MARK VIII 1995 and after MYSTIQUE
MERKUR: 1985-89 XR4TI 1988-89 SCORPIO
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980 and after F-150-350 SERIES 1981 and after ECONOLINE 1982 and after
BRONCO 1983 and after RANGER 1984-90 BRONCO II 1986 and after AEROSTAR 1988 and
after F SUPER DUTY 1991 and after EXPLORER 1993 and after VILLAGER 1995 and after
WINDSTAR
ISSUE: Rotunda Equipment has available a new piece of equipment for automatic transmission
fluid changes. Using the Rotunda ATF 2000 (199-00001) is an efficient way to change automatic
transmission fluid.
ACTION: When changing automatic transmission fluid using the Rotunda ATF 2000 (199-00001) it
is not necessary to remove the transmission pan and/or torque converter drainplug. Contact
Rotunda Equipment at 1-800-ROTUNDA for more information regarding the Rotunda ATF 2000.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS
CODES: 510000
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB078 > Nov > 91
> A/T - How To Use A Pressure Gauge
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - How To Use A Pressure
Gauge
BULLETIN : # 078
SUBJECT: Pressure Gauge
APPLICATION: Misc.
DATE: November 1991
HOW TO USE A PRESSURE GAUGE
A significant number of calls we receive involve improper pressures, so we need to use a pressure
gauge when diagnosing problems.
Using a pressure gauge can seem like a formidable task. The reason most people do not use a
pressure gauge is because they do not see the value in using one. Technicians do not see the
value because the gauge readings do not tell them how to fix the problem. This article will attempt
to show the technician how to interpret pressure gauge readings so the technician can find the fix
to the problem.
It is best to start pressure tests with mainline pressure. Mainline pressure should be checked in
each range: P, R, N, D, 3, 2, 1. Each range, except Park and Neutral, should be checked under
three conditions: Slow idle, fast idle, and wide open throttle. A form, as in figure 1 should be made
to record the readings.
If all pressures are within specification at slow idle then the pump and pressure regulator are
functioning properly.
If all pressures are low at slow idle, it indicates a potential problem in the pump, pressure regulator,
filter, low fluid, or internal leakage. To help verify where the problem is, check pressures at fast idle.
If all the pressures now read normally, it usually indicates a worn pump but the problem could still
be internal leaks.
Internal leaks will usually show up in a particular range. For example a forward clutch leak would
have normal pressure in Park, Reverse and Neutral but have low pressure in all forward ranges. A
direct clutch leak will show a pressure drop when the transmission shifts to third and low pressure
in reverse because in most cases, the direct clutch is on in third and reverse.
A restricted filter will usually show up as a gradual pressure drop at higher engine RPM because
the filter cannot pass as much fluid as the pump is trying to draw.
A stuck pressure regulator valve will show up as fixed line pressure which means the same
pressure all the time. The pressure may vary with engine RPM which means low pressure at slow
RPM and higher pressure at higher RPM. There will be no boost in pressure from the TV or
modulator system and no reverse boost.
If pressures are high at slow idle it indicates a pressure regulator or throttle pressure problem. On
most cars, the modulator controls throttle pressure. If the transmission has a throttle pressure tap, it
will tell you if the throttle pressure circuit is the problem. On GM units without a throttle pressure
tap, remove the TV plunger. If line pressure is now normal then it's a TV problem, if not it's a
pressure regulator problem.
Pressures also need to be checked at stall or wide open throttle (WOT). When doing a stall test,
always observe safety precautions such as checking for broken mounts or bad brakes. Testing
should always be done under operating conditions. To do a stall test, put the selector in the range
to be tested and with one foot firmly on the brake, press the accelerator to the floor then note your
pressure reading. Some technicians will pull the vacuum line off or pull the TV cable with the
engine at fast idle. That is not operating conditions and will not detect a problem of trapped vacuum
or a cable problem.
If all pressure at stall are low, then you should pull the TV cable to maximum or disconnect the
vacuum line. If the pressures are now OK, the problem is in the cable or vacuum system. If the
pressures are still low, then the problem is in the pump or control system.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB078 > Nov > 91
> A/T - How To Use A Pressure Gauge > Page 373
If all pressures at stall are high, then look at the idle pressures. If the idle pressures are also high
then this could be a pressure regulator or throttle system problem. If idle pressures are normal then
the problem is in just the throttle system.
The reverse stall test is also a maximum pump output test. If you suspect a weak pump then this
test will help find it. Often this will show up as low pressure at reverse stall but all other pressures
including idle will be normal. If a person wanted to become really proficient with a pressure gauge
they should first put a pressure gauge on their own vehicle and leave it there for exactly one week.
Every time they drive the car they should watch the gauge. After one week, they should then put
the pressure gauge on every single car in the shop that DOES NOT have a problem. Don't use the
gauge on cars WITH problems yet. After 30 days of using a gauge on units that work properly, they
can then start using the gauge on units with problems. The technician is accustomed to normal
readings, abnormal readings will stand out like a sore thumb.
To fix today's transmissions, every professional technician must be proficient in the use of a
pressure gauge. The only way to gain this proficiency is to use the pressure gauge daily. Practice
makes perfect.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB028 > Oct > 90
> A/T - Engine Vacuum Testing
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Engine Vacuum Testing
BULLETIN: # 028
DATE: October 1990
SUBJECT: Engine Testing With A Vacuum Gauge
TRANSMISSION: All
Engine Testing With A Vacuum Gauge
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION RELATIONS
An important part of transmission diagnosis is to make certain the engine operates properly. If the
engine performance is incorrect, the transmission will receive the wrong information.
The engine sends signals to the transmission through a vacuum line, throttle cable or both. These
signals basically synchronize torque with transmission line pressure, shift feel and shift timing.
Malfunctions in items like the air filter, spark plugs, EGR valves and other parts of the fuel,
electrical and emission systems could result in improper transmission performance.
VACUUM GAUGE ENGINE PERFORMANCE TESTING
A vacuum gauge shows the difference between outside atmospheric pressure and the amount of
vacuum present in the intake manifold.
The pistons in the engine serve as suction pumps and the amount of vacuum they create is
affected by the related actions of:
^ Piston rings
^ Valves
^ Ignition system
^ Fuel control system
^ Other parts affecting the combustion process (emission devices, etc.).
Each has a characteristic effect on vacuum and you judge their performance by watching variations
from normal.
It is important to judge engine performance by the general location and action of the needle on a
vacuum gauge, rather than just by a vacuum reading. Gauge readings which may be found are as
follows:
NORMAL ENGINE OPERATION
At idling speed, an engine at sea level should show a steady vacuum reading between 14" and 22"
HG. A quick opening and closing of the throttle should cause vacuum to drop below 5" then
rebound to 23" or more. See figure 1.
GENERAL IGNITION TROUBLES OR STICKING VALVES
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB028 > Oct > 90
> A/T - Engine Vacuum Testing > Page 378
With the engine idling, continued fluctuation of 1 to 2 inches may indicate an ignition problem.
Check the spark plugs, spark plug gap, primary ignition circuit, high tension cables, distributor cap
or ignition coil. Fluctuations of 3 to 4 inches may be sticking valves. See figure 2.
INTAKE SYSTEM LEAKAGE, VALVE TIMING, OR LOW COMPRESSION
A vacuum reading at idle much lower than normal can indicate leakage through intake manifold
gaskets, manifold-to-carburetor gaskets, vacuum brakes or the vacuum modulator. Low readings
could also be very late valve timing or worn piston rings. See figure 3.
EXHAUST BACK PRESSURE
Starting with the engine at idle, slowly increase engine speed to 3000 RPM, engine vacuum should
be equal to or higher than idle vacuum at 3000 RPM.
If vacuum decreases at higher engine RPM's, an excessive exhaust back pressure is probably
present.
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET LEAKAGE
With the engine Idling, the vacuum gauge pointer will drop sharply, every time the leak occurs. The
drop will be from the steady reading shown by the pointer to a reading of 10" to 12" Hg or less. If
the leak Is between two cylinders, the drop will be much greater. You can determine the location of
the leak by compression tests. See figure 4.
FUEL CONTROL SYSTEM TROUBLES
All other systems in an engine must be functioning properly before you check the fuel control
system as a cause for poor engine performance. If the pointer has a slow floating motion of 4 to 5
inches - you should check the fuel control.
BULLETIN RECAP
^ Engine problems can affect transmission performance.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB028 > Oct > 90
> A/T - Engine Vacuum Testing > Page 379
^ If you suspect an engine problem, connect a vacuum gauge to the intake manifold.
^ Note the location and action of the vacuum gauge needle.
^ Use the information in the bulletin to determine the engine problem.
^ Correct the engine problem before doing extensive calibration work on the transmission.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB9002006 > Feb
> 90 > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Choosing the Right ATF
TRANSMISSION: ALL
BULLETIN: # 9002006
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid
DATE: Feb 1990
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
CHOOSING YOUR ATF
Different ATF's (Automatic Transmission Fluid) can have different frictional properties which can
produce different shift characteristics. You may have already experienced problems like lock-up
shudder, or squawks on shifts and have corrected them by changing the fluid. This alone tells, you
that friction material and fluids are critical in today's cars.
MEETING THE O.E.M. SPECIFICATIONS
The first thing to consider when choosing an ATF is "Does it meet the O.E.M. specification?" ATF's
wishing to be labeled as DEXRON II and/or MERCON must first meet the respective minimum
requirements. It's important to note that even though the specification for DEXRON II and
MERCON are currently very similar, THEY ARE NOT IDENTICAL. Also note, even fluids which
meet the same specification may not be identical. One fluid may just meet a specification and,
another may far surpass it. You should know what your fluids properties are! You can get that
information from your fluid supplier.
EVALUATING YOUR FLUID
Ask your supplier to prove (certify) that the fluid meets O.E.M. specifications (MERCON OR
DEXRON II). He will do that by supplying you with the license (certification) number issued to him
by the O.E.M.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB9002006 > Feb
> 90 > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF > Page 384
A DEXRON-II license number (sometimes referred to as a "D" number) will always start D-2. A
typical DEXRON license number can be seen in Figure 2.
MERCON license numbers will be six digits starting with M as shown in Figure 3..
TRY TO MEET SEVERAL SPECIFICATIONS!
DEXRON II and MERCON have different minimum specifications, so a product that meets BOTH
specifications may be better then those meeting only one spec. Meeting other specs, in addition to
the first two can be an added benefit. If a fluid is licensed as DEXRON II AND MERCON as well as
others like Allison C-4, or Caterpillar TO-2/TO-4, it means the fluid had to pass more tests and may
be a better fluid.
Lastly, demand that the license numbers be placed on all your invoices especially if you buy in
bulk. If your supplier is unwilling, it is very likely that they are supplying you an unlicensed fluid.
Licensed suppliers are required to supply the license numbers to their customers as part of their
agreement with the O.E.M.
OTHER THINGS TO CHECK
So now you've narrowed your choices down to a few suppliers that have O.E.M. license numbers.
How do you compare two fluids that meet the same O.E.M. Spec.? Ask your supplier to give you
the viscometrics on the fluid you buy.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB9002006 > Feb
> 90 > A/T - Choosing the Right ATF > Page 385
An excellent "bench mark of the overall quality of a fluid is its viscosity at -40 degrees. This is
measured in "centipoise" or "cPs". DEXRON II specification says viscosity will be no more then
50,000 cPs @ - 40 degrees. (Some poor fluids have tested at over 1,000,000 cPs) In general, the
lower the number, the better the fluid.
Keep in mind that as the number goes down the price of the fluid usually goes up. (You get what
you pay for) Most good fluids will average around 35,000 cPs. Hydrotreated (or Hydrocracked)
fluids average around 20,000 cPs or less. (Hydrotreating is a refining process done to the base oil
to clean out contaminants or impurities) Synthetic ATF's average 10,000 cPs or less, and some are
as low as 5000 cPs. Viscosity at -40 degrees is a function of the base stock from which the ATF is
made. A low number indicates a premium base oil OR an expensive refining process.
(Hydrotreating)
FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION:
Transmission Digest August '89 Page 91 December '89 Page 51
BULLETIN RECAP
^ Only use fluids with O.E.M. approvals.
^ Try to get a fluid that meets more than one spec (e.g DEXRON II AND MERCON)
^ Check the viscosity at -40 degrees. The lower the number the better.
^ Avoid bargain basement fluids with no license numbers.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8930 > Oct > 89
> A/T - Math Part II
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Math Part II
TSB: 89-30 (Oct)
SUBJECT: TRANSMISSION MATH - Part II
Planetary Gear Sets:
Knowing the gear ratios of an automatic transmission can come in handy at times -- especially
when you're swapping transmission types or differentials. The problem is in trying to find a manual
with the ratios listed. What do you do?
BREAK OUT THE CALCULATOR, AND FIGURE IT OUT.
When you figure the gear ratios for planetary gear sets, it is just like any other gear set. You divide
the output gear by the input. Also, don't count the idler gear; planetaries are considered idler gears.
Set them aside, their tooth count doesn't matter.
Now for the tricky part -- which gear do you consider the input, and which one the output? Figure 1
shows a planetary gear set with 34 teeth on the ring gear and 20 teeth on the Sun gear.
FOR GEAR REDUCTION, one of the gears is held stationary, and the other is used for the INPUT.
THE TOOTH COUNT FOR THE OUTPUT GEAR IS THE SUM OF THE SUN GEAR AND THE
RING GEAR, so if you are using the Sun gear for the input, then the ring gear + the Sun gear
divided by the Sun gear = Ratio.
EXAMPLE: 34 + 20 divided by 20 = 2.7:1 This is how 1st gear on a THM 700 R4 is calculated.
(See figure)
When the ring gear is used as the input, then the ring gear + the Sun gear divided by the ring gear
= Ratio.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8930 > Oct > 89
> A/T - Math Part II > Page 390
EXAMPLE: 34 + 20 divided by 34 = 1.58 This is now 2nd gear on a THM 350 is calculated. (See
figure)
FOR OVERDRIVE, the sum of the ring gear + Sun gear is used for the input tooth count.
So, IF THE SUN GEAR IS HELD, then the ring gear divided by (ring gear + Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 34 divided by (34 + 20) = .63:1 Look familiar?
The A4LD, the THM 200-4R, the A-140E, the A-40D, the THM 325-4L are some of the units that
use this method of getting overdrive. (See figure)
If the ring gear is held, then the Sun gear divided by (ring gear = Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 20 divided by (34 + 20) = .37:1 (See figure)
REVERSE IS THE EASIEST - THE PLANET IS HELD.
The Sun gear is the input, and the ring gear is the output. The formula for this is: The ring gear
divided by the Sun gear = Ratio.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8930 > Oct > 89
> A/T - Math Part II > Page 391
EXAMPLE: 34 divided by 20 = 1.7 (See figure)
Occasionally, the ring gear is used as the input, and the Sun gear as the output.
The formula for this is: The Sun gear divided by the ring gear = Ratio.
EXAMPLE: 20 divided by 34 = .59 (See figure)
Notice that the output is overdriven.
A transmission using this method must use another planetary gear set to reduce the output. The
Mercedes W3A-040 is a good example of this
To get more than one gear forward and a reverse, requires multiple, or compound planetary gear
sets.
Two of the most common of these are the SIMPSON GEAR SET, used in transmissions like the
THM 350, the Ford C-4, and the TF 6 & 8, and the RAVIGNEAUX GEAR SET, found in
transmissions such as the FMX, the AOD, and the T-35.
Figuring out all the ratios for these transmissions is a little tricky, so I'll give you the formulas, and
let you figure out how these formulas were derived.
THE SIMPSON GEAR SET:
For this example I'll use a THM 200, which has 74 TEETH ON THE FRONT RING GEAR, 42
TEETH ON THE FRONT SUN GEAR, 30 TEETH ON THE REAR SUN GEAR, AND 62 TEETH ON
THE REAR RING GEAR.
The formula for 1ST GEAR is: rear ring divided by rear Sun x front Sun plus front Sun + front ring
divided by front ring.
EXAMPLE: On the THM 200, it would be:
62 divided by 30 x 42 + 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 2.74:1
SECOND GEAR is easy: Front Sun + front ring divided by front ring.
EXAMPLE: 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 1.57:1
THIRD GEAR is Direct Drive, or 1:1
REVERSE is rear ring divided by rear Sun
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by 30 = 2.06
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8930 > Oct > 89
> A/T - Math Part II > Page 392
THM 440-T4 (BACKWARDS SIMPSON):
The THM 440 T4 is sort of a backwards version of a Simpson gear set, and although it looks
complicated, it really is very simple.
The front Sun gear has 26 teeth, while the rear Sun gear has 42. The front ring gear has 62 teeth,
but keep in mind that it is part of the rear carrier, just as the rear ring gear is part of the front carrier,
with a tooth count of 74.
As I said earlier, the THM 440 T4 is sort of a backwards version of a Simpson gear set, so in
figuring the ratio for 1ST GEAR -- it is identical, except you substitute the words "front" and "rear" in
the appropriate places. Front ring divided by front sun x rear Sun + rear Sun + rear ring divided by
rear ring = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by 26 x 42 + 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 2.92:1
2ND GEAR: Rear Sun + rear ring divided by rear ring
Example: 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 1.57:1
3RD GEAR: Direct Drive, or 1:1
4TH GEAR: Front ring divided by (front Sun + front ring = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by (26 + 62) = .74:1
RAVIGNEAUX GEAR SET:
This is considered a compound gear set, and for this example I'll use an AOD, which has:
36 teeth on the front Sun gear
30 teeth on the rear Sun gear, and 72 teeth on the ring gear
The formula for first gear is: Ring gear divided by rear Sun gear = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by 30 = 2.4:1
SECOND GEAR formula is: Rear Sun + front Sun divided by rear Sun x Ring divided by (Ring +
front Sun)
EXAMPLE: (30 + 36) divided by 30 x 72 divided by (72 + 36) = Ratio 66 divided by 30 x 72 divided
by 108 = 1.47
THIRD GEAR is Direct, or 1:1
FOURTH GEAR is: Ring gear divided by (ring gear + front Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by (72 + 36) = .67:1
REVERSE on a Ford AOD is: Ring gear divided by front Sun gear.
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by 36 = 2:1
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8927 > Sep > 89
> A/T - Twenty Steps To Successful Repairs
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Twenty Steps To Successful
Repairs
TSB 89-27 (Sept)
SUBJECT: TWENTY STEPS TO SUCCESSFUL TRANSMISSION REPAIR
1. As you start work on a transmission, read your ATRA bulletins pertaining to that transmission. (If
you do this every time, before you know it you'll have the bulletins memorized.)
2. Clean the entire transmission, including the valve body.
3. Check pumps, valve bodies, and cases for warpage.
4. Flat file pumps, valve bodies, and cases. (Just a few strokes with the file to knock off high spots
and handle burrs.)
5. Check all pump gear clearances.
6. Check planet pinion endplay and side to side motion.
7. Soak all planet assemblies.
8. Soak all friction material for 15-30 minutes.
9. Sand, tumble, or replace all steel plates.
10. Re-surface all drums on which a band rides.
11. Replace all rotating oi1 control rings.
12. Check all oil control rings, and rubber products in their bores for proper fit.
13. Replace all major support bushings and bushings that control lube oil.
14. Pre-lubricate all bushings and thrust washers.
15. Pre-lube pumps.
16. Pre-fill torque converters.
17. Use available manuals to find specifications.
18. Set correct clutch and band clearances
19. Take the time to set total unit endplay
20. Use a torque wrench on all pumps and valve bodies.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8923 > Aug > 89
> A/T - Math Formulas Part I
Technical Service Bulletin # ATRATB8923 Date: 890801
A/T - Math Formulas Part I
TSB: 89-23 (Aug)
SUBJECT: TRANSMISSION MATH FORMULAS (Your most valuable tool)
Transmission math formulas are not reserved exclusively for engineers. Understanding some basic
mathematical formulas can be one of your most valuable tools.
The following information contained in this bulletin will discuss various basic formulas dealing with:
1. Shift Speed
2. Pressure
3. Speedometer ratios
Take the time, now, to understand these relatively simple concepts.
You will be saving yourself many problems, and considerable frustration, and also dollars, in the
future.
Shift Speed and Pressure
SHIFT SPEED AND PRESSURE
To figure the area of a circle (valve or servo):
Radius (which is 1/2 the diameter) x Radius x 3.14159 = Area
EXAMPLE: A 1" diameter circle has a radius of 0.5"
0.5 x 0.5 x 3.14159 = 0.785
Therefore a 1" diameter circle has an Area of 0.785 sq. inches
Pressure x Area = Force
EXAMPLE: 100 psi line pressure, on a servo with an area of 2 square inches = force
So, 100 psi line pressure x 2 sq in = 200 pounds of force.
Force divided by Area = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 200 lbs divided by 2" = 100 psi
Force divided by Pressure = Area
EXAMPLE: 200 lbs divided by 100 psi = 2 inches
THINGS WE CAN DO WITH THESE FORMULAS:
EXAMPLE: A 700 R4 has 62 psi of line pressure at Idle. The PR spring weighs 6.5 lbs
The tip (reaction end) of the PR valve has a diameter of 0.365" (0.365 divided by 2 = 0.1825
radius) 0.1825 x 0.1825 x 3.14159 = 0.1046" area
We want 75 psi of line pressure at Idle
First, let's see if those numbers add up, using: Pressure x Area = Force
62 psi x 0.1046 = 6.48, or 6 1/2 lb PR Spring
We want 75 psi: Pressure x Area = Force (Spring) 75 psi x 0.1046 = 7.85 lb spring
What if we put in an 8 lb Spring? Force divided by Area = Pressure
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8923 > Aug > 89
> A/T - Math Formulas Part I > Page 401
8 lbs divided by 0.1046 = 76.48 or 76 1/2 line pressure
Now, let's look at RATIO.
Ratio is the relationship in quantity, amount or size, between two or more things.
In our example ratio is: How many psi each pound of spring will add.
Pressure divided by Force = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 psi divided by 6.5 lbs = 9.5 ratio Each pound of spring will increase pressure 9.5 psi
Force x Ratio = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 6.5 lbs x 9.5 = 61.75 or 62 psi
(Let's add 1 lb of spring, and see if we get 9.5 more psi.)
Force x Ratio = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 7.5 lbs x 9.5 = 71.25
New pressure Old pressure = Pressure difference
71.25 minus 61.75 = 9.5 psi change (by adding 1 lb of spring)
Once you know the ratio, a lot can be determined. Pressure divided by Ratio = Force
62 psi (actually 61.75) divided by 9.5 = 6.5 lb spring
The ratio never changes. This means that if I know that line pressure is 55 psi at idle, in a 700 R4,
the the PR spring must be 5.78 lbs.
Pressure divided by Ratio = Force
So, 55 psi divided by 9.5 = 5.78 lbs.
Now, let's look at a math formula for shift speeds.
Suppose we had shift speeds of 15 mph and 20 mph, for the 1-2 & 2-3 shifts on a transmission. 20
mph may be too early for the 2-3 shift. If we adjust TV modulator, we will move both shifts. We don't
want to do that because the 1-2 shift is fine, so let's work with just the 2-3 shift spring.
EXAMPLE: Original spring divided by Original MPH = Ratio
As, 4 lbs divided by 25mph = 0.2
Ratio x Desired MPH = New Spring
0.2 x 25 mph = 5 lb spring
A 5 lb spring will raise the shift on this transmission to 25 mph.
All you need to know is -- Where is it shifting now (at MINIMUM throttle) and what does the spring
weigh.
This formula will get you very close, but may be a "tad" off, because we are not accounting for TV
pressure helping the spring. This is why you want to check it at minimum throttle, so TV has the
least effect.
Speedometer Ratios
Finally, let's look at speedometer ratios.
Suppose we put an exchange transmission in a car, and now the speedometer is off, because the
speedometer drive gear has a different tooth count. What do we have to do to the driven gear to
correct it?
Let's say the old drive gear had 7 teeth and the old driven gear had 21 teeth. The exchange unit
had 8 teeth on the drive gear.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8923 > Aug > 89
> A/T - Math Formulas Part I > Page 402
Old Drive Gear divided by the New Drive Gear = Ratio
7 teeth divided by 8 teeth = 0.875
Old Driven Gear divided by Ratio = New Driven Gear
21 teeth divided by 0.875 = 24 teeth
A 24 tooth driven gear will correct the speedometer error.
Let's do one more speedometer change. This time the old drive is 9, and the new drive is 10. The
old driven gear is still 21.
Old Drive Gear divided by New Drive Gear = Ratio
9 tooth divided by 10 tooth = 0.9
Old Driven Gear divided by Ratio = New Driven Gear
21 tooth divided by 0.9 = 23.33 teeth
We can't get a 23.3 tooth count so we round it off to 23 teeth. Now the speedometer will be close,
but not exact, because we had to round off the number.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > 8912289614 > Jun > 89 >
Adhesives & Sealants - Availability and Usage
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins Adhesives & Sealants - Availability
and Usage
^ ADHESIVES AND SEALANTS-AVAILABILITY AND USAGE
^ ENGINE-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTS-AVILABILITY AND USAGE
^ STEERING-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTSAVAILABILITY AND USAGE
^ TRANSMISSION-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTSAVAILABILITY AND USAGE
Article No. 89-12-2
FORD: 1989 and prior ALL FORD LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1989 and prior ALL LINCOLN-MERCURY LINES
MERKUR: 1989 and prior ALL MERKUR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1989 and prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1989 and prior ALL MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: Various adhesives and sealants are used to perform many service repairs. A partial list of
these Ford products that are available through the Ford Parts System along with their proper use
and application is shown below.
ACTION: If adhesives and sealants are required to perform a service repair, refer to the following
product information and the appropriate Shop Manual.
Ford Stud And Bearing Mount (EOAZ-19554-BA)/ Ford Threadlocker 262 (E2FZ-19554-B)
These adhesives are high strength threadlockers. They are used for locking all fasteners that must
withstand:
^ Heavy shock and vibration.
^ Extreme chemical and environmental conditions, such as solvents, oils, and water immersion.
They prevent fluid/vacuum leaks and seal out rust or corrosion. Their typical applications include
securing the following items.
^ Intake manifold bolts
^ Power steering pump adjusting bolts
^ Engine studs
^ Ring gear bolts
^ Seat bolts
^ Cup plugs
To use these adhesives, clean the fastener threads with a wire brush and a non-petroleum based
solvent. Apply one or two drops to the threads and torque to the required specifications.
NOTE: THESE ARE HIGH STRENGTH THREADLOCKERS AND THEY REQUIRE SPECIAL
EFFORT FOR REMOVAL.
Ford Threadlock And Sealer (EOAZ-19554-AA)
This product is a medium strength threadlocker and sealer which stops air, oil, and fuel leakage. It
is a hand tool removable adhesive and is used on aluminum threads. It prevents fluid/vacuum leaks
and seals out rust or corrosion. Its typical applications include sealing and securing the following
items.
^ Oil pan bolts
^ Valve cover bolts
^ Flywheel attaching bolts
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > 8912289614 > Jun > 89 >
Adhesives & Sealants - Availability and Usage > Page 407
^ Door latch attaching bolts
To use this adhesive, clean the fastener threads with a wire brush and a non-petroleum based
solvent. Apply one or two drops to the threads and torque to the required specifications. Ford Pipe
Sealant With Teflon (D8AZ-19554-A)
This product seals and locks air, oil, fuel and hydraulic threaded fasteners. This light paste sealant
instantly seals without fouling. It is non-shredding and operates in temperatures up to 400~F. It
prevents corrosion of fitting /fastener threads and locks against vibrational loosening. Its typical
applications include sealing the following items.
^ Transmission oil coolant lines
^ Fuel inlet fittings
^ Intake manifold vacuum switches
^ Engine oil galley plugs
To use this sealer, clean off residual oil, coolant and other contaminants from the threads. Apply
sealer completely around the second and third threads. Install the part and torque to the required
specifications.
Ford Gasket Maker (E2AZ-19562-B) And Ford Gasket Eliminator (E1FZ-19562-A)
These products cure in the absence of air. They are used to gasket two machined surfaced
flanges. Each product will fill a gap up to .010". The sealants will not cure until the parts are
assembled. Once cured, they will remain pliable and flex with movement of the parts. Their typical
applications include sealing the following items.
^ Oil dip stick tubes
^ MTX case halves (Gasket Eliminator)
^ Water Pumps
^ Input bearing retainers
^ Rear main bearing parting lines
To use these sealants, make sure all the old gasket material has been removed. CAUTION: AVOID
USING METAL SCRAPERS BECAUSE THEY CAN ETCH THE SURFACES AND PREVENT A
GOOD SEAL.
Clean both surfaces with a non-petroleum based solvent to remove all oil, grease and other
contaminants. Apply a small bead of sealant continuously around one surface only and then put the
pieces together.
NOTE: REMEMBER, THESE PRODUCTS CURE IN THE ABSENCE OF AIR, SO PLENTY OF
TIME IS AVAILABLE TO DO A THOROUGH JOB.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E0AZ-19554-BA Stud and Bearings Mount BM
E2FZ-19554-B Ford Threadlocker 262 R
E0AZ-19554-AA Threadlock and Sealer B
D8AZ-19554-A Pipe Sealant with Teflon B
E2AZ-19562-B Gasket Maker AM
E1FZ-19562-A Gasket Eliminator AM
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8754 > Sep > 87
> A/T - Front Bushing Wear
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Front Bushing Wear
TSB 87-54 (Sept)
SUBJECT: ALL AUTOMATICS
PROBLEM: Front Bushing Wear
CAUSE: When diagnosing front pump bushing wear, the cause may be:
1. Excessive CONVERTER HUB RUN-OUT. This may, or may not be due to a faulty torque
converter.
The torque converter can be checked visually, and with a dial indicator. (See Figure 1) Hub run-out
should not exceed .010".
2. BROKEN, BENT OR CRACKED FLYWHEELS can also cause run-out. If the
torque-converter-to-flywheel bolts have been loose, the flywheel holes can become egg-shaped, or
the torque converter pads may wear into the flywheel, causing run-out.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8754 > Sep > 87
> A/T - Front Bushing Wear > Page 412
3. Another possibility is WEAR IN THE CRANKSHAFT, where it supports the torque converter
pilot.(See Figure 2)
Often the crankshaft is only worn in a small area where the torque converter pilot has been against
it.
If only a portion of the crankshaft is worn, rotate the crankshaft until the worn area is at 12:00
o'clock.
When the torque converter is pushed forward into the crankshaft, the torque converter pilot will
bottom on a good portion, and should center properly.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8748 > Aug > 87
> A/T - Slipping or No-Shift/Metal Sealing Rings
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Slipping or No-Shift/Metal
Sealing Rings
TSB 87-48 (Aug)
SUBJECT: Metal sealing rings
Various Units
PROBLEM: Slipping, or sometimes no-shift
POSSIBLE SOLUTION: Sealing rings could be under-size.
1. Always inspect rings as outlined in SIL 84-29
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > ATRATB8748 > Aug > 87
> A/T - Slipping or No-Shift/Metal Sealing Rings > Page 417
2. Place ring in bore of drum where they will be running. (See Figures 1 & 2)
3. Sealing rings should be snug in bore; rings should fit all around the drum. (drum could be
out-of-round)
4. Air check all drums. (Use 30 PSI air pressure only.) If air escapes you have leaks -- better find
now, than later. This represents lost clutch pressure, and could result in soft application and burned
friction material.
5. Following these steps will help you save money, plus help you build better units.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 418
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Math Part II
TSB: 89-30 (Oct)
SUBJECT: TRANSMISSION MATH - Part II
Planetary Gear Sets:
Knowing the gear ratios of an automatic transmission can come in handy at times -- especially
when you're swapping transmission types or differentials. The problem is in trying to find a manual
with the ratios listed. What do you do?
BREAK OUT THE CALCULATOR, AND FIGURE IT OUT.
When you figure the gear ratios for planetary gear sets, it is just like any other gear set. You divide
the output gear by the input. Also, don't count the idler gear; planetaries are considered idler gears.
Set them aside, their tooth count doesn't matter.
Now for the tricky part -- which gear do you consider the input, and which one the output? Figure 1
shows a planetary gear set with 34 teeth on the ring gear and 20 teeth on the Sun gear.
FOR GEAR REDUCTION, one of the gears is held stationary, and the other is used for the INPUT.
THE TOOTH COUNT FOR THE OUTPUT GEAR IS THE SUM OF THE SUN GEAR AND THE
RING GEAR, so if you are using the Sun gear for the input, then the ring gear + the Sun gear
divided by the Sun gear = Ratio.
EXAMPLE: 34 + 20 divided by 20 = 2.7:1 This is how 1st gear on a THM 700 R4 is calculated.
(See figure)
When the ring gear is used as the input, then the ring gear + the Sun gear divided by the ring gear
= Ratio.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 419
EXAMPLE: 34 + 20 divided by 34 = 1.58 This is now 2nd gear on a THM 350 is calculated. (See
figure)
FOR OVERDRIVE, the sum of the ring gear + Sun gear is used for the input tooth count.
So, IF THE SUN GEAR IS HELD, then the ring gear divided by (ring gear + Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 34 divided by (34 + 20) = .63:1 Look familiar?
The A4LD, the THM 200-4R, the A-140E, the A-40D, the THM 325-4L are some of the units that
use this method of getting overdrive. (See figure)
If the ring gear is held, then the Sun gear divided by (ring gear = Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 20 divided by (34 + 20) = .37:1 (See figure)
REVERSE IS THE EASIEST - THE PLANET IS HELD.
The Sun gear is the input, and the ring gear is the output. The formula for this is: The ring gear
divided by the Sun gear = Ratio.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 420
EXAMPLE: 34 divided by 20 = 1.7 (See figure)
Occasionally, the ring gear is used as the input, and the Sun gear as the output.
The formula for this is: The Sun gear divided by the ring gear = Ratio.
EXAMPLE: 20 divided by 34 = .59 (See figure)
Notice that the output is overdriven.
A transmission using this method must use another planetary gear set to reduce the output. The
Mercedes W3A-040 is a good example of this
To get more than one gear forward and a reverse, requires multiple, or compound planetary gear
sets.
Two of the most common of these are the SIMPSON GEAR SET, used in transmissions like the
THM 350, the Ford C-4, and the TF 6 & 8, and the RAVIGNEAUX GEAR SET, found in
transmissions such as the FMX, the AOD, and the T-35.
Figuring out all the ratios for these transmissions is a little tricky, so I'll give you the formulas, and
let you figure out how these formulas were derived.
THE SIMPSON GEAR SET:
For this example I'll use a THM 200, which has 74 TEETH ON THE FRONT RING GEAR, 42
TEETH ON THE FRONT SUN GEAR, 30 TEETH ON THE REAR SUN GEAR, AND 62 TEETH ON
THE REAR RING GEAR.
The formula for 1ST GEAR is: rear ring divided by rear Sun x front Sun plus front Sun + front ring
divided by front ring.
EXAMPLE: On the THM 200, it would be:
62 divided by 30 x 42 + 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 2.74:1
SECOND GEAR is easy: Front Sun + front ring divided by front ring.
EXAMPLE: 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 1.57:1
THIRD GEAR is Direct Drive, or 1:1
REVERSE is rear ring divided by rear Sun
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by 30 = 2.06
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 421
THM 440-T4 (BACKWARDS SIMPSON):
The THM 440 T4 is sort of a backwards version of a Simpson gear set, and although it looks
complicated, it really is very simple.
The front Sun gear has 26 teeth, while the rear Sun gear has 42. The front ring gear has 62 teeth,
but keep in mind that it is part of the rear carrier, just as the rear ring gear is part of the front carrier,
with a tooth count of 74.
As I said earlier, the THM 440 T4 is sort of a backwards version of a Simpson gear set, so in
figuring the ratio for 1ST GEAR -- it is identical, except you substitute the words "front" and "rear" in
the appropriate places. Front ring divided by front sun x rear Sun + rear Sun + rear ring divided by
rear ring = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by 26 x 42 + 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 2.92:1
2ND GEAR: Rear Sun + rear ring divided by rear ring
Example: 42 + 74 divided by 74 = 1.57:1
3RD GEAR: Direct Drive, or 1:1
4TH GEAR: Front ring divided by (front Sun + front ring = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 divided by (26 + 62) = .74:1
RAVIGNEAUX GEAR SET:
This is considered a compound gear set, and for this example I'll use an AOD, which has:
36 teeth on the front Sun gear
30 teeth on the rear Sun gear, and 72 teeth on the ring gear
The formula for first gear is: Ring gear divided by rear Sun gear = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by 30 = 2.4:1
SECOND GEAR formula is: Rear Sun + front Sun divided by rear Sun x Ring divided by (Ring +
front Sun)
EXAMPLE: (30 + 36) divided by 30 x 72 divided by (72 + 36) = Ratio 66 divided by 30 x 72 divided
by 108 = 1.47
THIRD GEAR is Direct, or 1:1
FOURTH GEAR is: Ring gear divided by (ring gear + front Sun gear) = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by (72 + 36) = .67:1
REVERSE on a Ford AOD is: Ring gear divided by front Sun gear.
EXAMPLE: 72 divided by 36 = 2:1
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 422
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Twenty Steps To Successful
Repairs
TSB 89-27 (Sept)
SUBJECT: TWENTY STEPS TO SUCCESSFUL TRANSMISSION REPAIR
1. As you start work on a transmission, read your ATRA bulletins pertaining to that transmission. (If
you do this every time, before you know it you'll have the bulletins memorized.)
2. Clean the entire transmission, including the valve body.
3. Check pumps, valve bodies, and cases for warpage.
4. Flat file pumps, valve bodies, and cases. (Just a few strokes with the file to knock off high spots
and handle burrs.)
5. Check all pump gear clearances.
6. Check planet pinion endplay and side to side motion.
7. Soak all planet assemblies.
8. Soak all friction material for 15-30 minutes.
9. Sand, tumble, or replace all steel plates.
10. Re-surface all drums on which a band rides.
11. Replace all rotating oi1 control rings.
12. Check all oil control rings, and rubber products in their bores for proper fit.
13. Replace all major support bushings and bushings that control lube oil.
14. Pre-lubricate all bushings and thrust washers.
15. Pre-lube pumps.
16. Pre-fill torque converters.
17. Use available manuals to find specifications.
18. Set correct clutch and band clearances
19. Take the time to set total unit endplay
20. Use a torque wrench on all pumps and valve bodies.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 423
Technical Service Bulletin # ATRATB8923 Date: 890801
A/T - Math Formulas Part I
TSB: 89-23 (Aug)
SUBJECT: TRANSMISSION MATH FORMULAS (Your most valuable tool)
Transmission math formulas are not reserved exclusively for engineers. Understanding some basic
mathematical formulas can be one of your most valuable tools.
The following information contained in this bulletin will discuss various basic formulas dealing with:
1. Shift Speed
2. Pressure
3. Speedometer ratios
Take the time, now, to understand these relatively simple concepts.
You will be saving yourself many problems, and considerable frustration, and also dollars, in the
future.
Shift Speed and Pressure
SHIFT SPEED AND PRESSURE
To figure the area of a circle (valve or servo):
Radius (which is 1/2 the diameter) x Radius x 3.14159 = Area
EXAMPLE: A 1" diameter circle has a radius of 0.5"
0.5 x 0.5 x 3.14159 = 0.785
Therefore a 1" diameter circle has an Area of 0.785 sq. inches
Pressure x Area = Force
EXAMPLE: 100 psi line pressure, on a servo with an area of 2 square inches = force
So, 100 psi line pressure x 2 sq in = 200 pounds of force.
Force divided by Area = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 200 lbs divided by 2" = 100 psi
Force divided by Pressure = Area
EXAMPLE: 200 lbs divided by 100 psi = 2 inches
THINGS WE CAN DO WITH THESE FORMULAS:
EXAMPLE: A 700 R4 has 62 psi of line pressure at Idle. The PR spring weighs 6.5 lbs
The tip (reaction end) of the PR valve has a diameter of 0.365" (0.365 divided by 2 = 0.1825
radius) 0.1825 x 0.1825 x 3.14159 = 0.1046" area
We want 75 psi of line pressure at Idle
First, let's see if those numbers add up, using: Pressure x Area = Force
62 psi x 0.1046 = 6.48, or 6 1/2 lb PR Spring
We want 75 psi: Pressure x Area = Force (Spring) 75 psi x 0.1046 = 7.85 lb spring
What if we put in an 8 lb Spring? Force divided by Area = Pressure
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 424
8 lbs divided by 0.1046 = 76.48 or 76 1/2 line pressure
Now, let's look at RATIO.
Ratio is the relationship in quantity, amount or size, between two or more things.
In our example ratio is: How many psi each pound of spring will add.
Pressure divided by Force = Ratio
EXAMPLE: 62 psi divided by 6.5 lbs = 9.5 ratio Each pound of spring will increase pressure 9.5 psi
Force x Ratio = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 6.5 lbs x 9.5 = 61.75 or 62 psi
(Let's add 1 lb of spring, and see if we get 9.5 more psi.)
Force x Ratio = Pressure
EXAMPLE: 7.5 lbs x 9.5 = 71.25
New pressure Old pressure = Pressure difference
71.25 minus 61.75 = 9.5 psi change (by adding 1 lb of spring)
Once you know the ratio, a lot can be determined. Pressure divided by Ratio = Force
62 psi (actually 61.75) divided by 9.5 = 6.5 lb spring
The ratio never changes. This means that if I know that line pressure is 55 psi at idle, in a 700 R4,
the the PR spring must be 5.78 lbs.
Pressure divided by Ratio = Force
So, 55 psi divided by 9.5 = 5.78 lbs.
Now, let's look at a math formula for shift speeds.
Suppose we had shift speeds of 15 mph and 20 mph, for the 1-2 & 2-3 shifts on a transmission. 20
mph may be too early for the 2-3 shift. If we adjust TV modulator, we will move both shifts. We don't
want to do that because the 1-2 shift is fine, so let's work with just the 2-3 shift spring.
EXAMPLE: Original spring divided by Original MPH = Ratio
As, 4 lbs divided by 25mph = 0.2
Ratio x Desired MPH = New Spring
0.2 x 25 mph = 5 lb spring
A 5 lb spring will raise the shift on this transmission to 25 mph.
All you need to know is -- Where is it shifting now (at MINIMUM throttle) and what does the spring
weigh.
This formula will get you very close, but may be a "tad" off, because we are not accounting for TV
pressure helping the spring. This is why you want to check it at minimum throttle, so TV has the
least effect.
Speedometer Ratios
Finally, let's look at speedometer ratios.
Suppose we put an exchange transmission in a car, and now the speedometer is off, because the
speedometer drive gear has a different tooth count. What do we have to do to the driven gear to
correct it?
Let's say the old drive gear had 7 teeth and the old driven gear had 21 teeth. The exchange unit
had 8 teeth on the drive gear.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Automatic Transmission/Transaxle: > Page 425
Old Drive Gear divided by the New Drive Gear = Ratio
7 teeth divided by 8 teeth = 0.875
Old Driven Gear divided by Ratio = New Driven Gear
21 teeth divided by 0.875 = 24 teeth
A 24 tooth driven gear will correct the speedometer error.
Let's do one more speedometer change. This time the old drive is 9, and the new drive is 10. The
old driven gear is still 21.
Old Drive Gear divided by New Drive Gear = Ratio
9 tooth divided by 10 tooth = 0.9
Old Driven Gear divided by Ratio = New Driven Gear
21 tooth divided by 0.9 = 23.33 teeth
We can't get a 23.3 tooth count so we round it off to 23 teeth. Now the speedometer will be close,
but not exact, because we had to round off the number.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Differential Pinion Bolt - Removal Aid
Pinion Gear: Technical Service Bulletins Differential Pinion Bolt - Removal Aid
Article No. 84-6-15
AXLE - FORD-BUILT CAST CENTER AXLES - AID TO BOLT REMOVAL PROCEDURE FOR
DIFFERENTIAL PINION SHAFT LOCK BOLT
FORD
1977-84 FORD CARLINES WITH 7.5", 8.5", 8.7", 8.8" REAR AXLES
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1977-84 LINCOLN-MERCURY CARLINES WITH 7.5", 8.5", 8.7", 8.8" REAR
AXLES
LIGHT TRUCKS 1977-84 LIGHT TRUCKS WITH 7.5", 8.8" REAR AXLES
The subject bolt head may round off during removal with a conventional wrench or socket. To
eliminate this condition, a socket type wrench may be made from a 3/8-inch Allen head bolt and a
steel rod.
FIGURE 12
Cut the Allen head from the bolt and weld the head to the 6" rod. The rod will serve as a handle
(Figure 12). In addition, the recess in the Allen head fits the 5/16-inch head in the differential pinion
shaft lock bolt precisely.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob Pulls Off
Shifter M/T: Customer Interest Shift Lever Knob - Pulls Off
Article No. 83-19-17
TRANSMISSION/TRANSFER CASES - SHIFT KNOB - PULLS OFF FLOOR SHIFT LEVER
LIGHT TRUCKS 1982-84 ALL MODEL LIGHT TRUCKS
Figure 17
Shift lever knob "pull-off" may be due to knob damage during installation or lever knurling which is
out of specification. The following procedure is to identify the cause and to service the condition
(See Figure 17).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob Pulls Off > Page 440
1. Remove the shift ball from the shift lever assembly by removing the plastic shift pattern insert
from the shift ball. Knock the ball off the lever with a block of wood and a hammer.
2. Inspect the lower cavity of the shift ball for broken or missing sections. Discard the ball if broken
or missing pieces are noted. (Retain the plastic shift pattern insert).
3. On T-19 transmission inspect the knurled end of the
shift lever for undersize/oversize knurling by measuring the knurled diameter. The knurled diameter
should be between 37/64" and 19/32" in diameter. 4.
If the diameter of the knurled section is less than the specified 37/64" minimum, then the shift lever
should be replaced with a new one with good knurls. Also install a new shift ball with the new lever.
Figure 17
5. If the knurled diameter is within the specified diameter, replace the shift ball (7213) only, using
the original shift lever and shift ball insert.
NOTE: Before installing the shift ball on the transmission shift lever and, using a machinist file or
suitable hand grinder, file or grind a radius
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob Pulls Off > Page 441
or chamfer on the lever and the start of the knurls so as to remove the step from the top end of the
lever and (Figure 17, View A) to aid installation.
6. Install the shift lever ball by warming the ball with a heat gun to 140~ - 180~ and tapping the ball
onto the shift lever with a 7/16" socket and a rubber hammer or mallet. Tap the ball down to the
beginning of the taper below the knurled section as shown in Figure 17, View A. Install the shift pattern
insert. NOTE:
Tap the shift ball down on the shift lever to the beginning of the tapered shoulder (Figure 17, View
A) below the knurled section of the shift lever assembly.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E2TZ-7213-B Shift Ball B
E2TZ-7210-D Shift Lever T-18 R
E3TZ-7210-N Shift Lever T-19 C
E2TZ-7210-C Shift Lever NPG435 B
E2TZ-7210-L Shift Lever SROD R
E2TZ-7210-E Shift Lever M4OD R
E3TZ-7210-A Shift Lever TK 4 spd. C
E4TZ-7210-C Shift Lever TK 5 spd.* C
E2TZ-7210-B Shift Lever NP208/W1345 C
E3TZ-7210-K Shift Lever W-1350 C
* - Shift lever assembly includes shift tower.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 82-7-17 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION/TIME: Refer to the Labor Time
Standards Manual for applicable operation and time. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 7213 or 7210
Code:
01 or 16 as applicable.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift
Lever Knob - Pulls Off
Shifter M/T: All Technical Service Bulletins Shift Lever Knob - Pulls Off
Article No. 83-19-17
TRANSMISSION/TRANSFER CASES - SHIFT KNOB - PULLS OFF FLOOR SHIFT LEVER
LIGHT TRUCKS 1982-84 ALL MODEL LIGHT TRUCKS
Figure 17
Shift lever knob "pull-off" may be due to knob damage during installation or lever knurling which is
out of specification. The following procedure is to identify the cause and to service the condition
(See Figure 17).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift
Lever Knob - Pulls Off > Page 447
1. Remove the shift ball from the shift lever assembly by removing the plastic shift pattern insert
from the shift ball. Knock the ball off the lever with a block of wood and a hammer.
2. Inspect the lower cavity of the shift ball for broken or missing sections. Discard the ball if broken
or missing pieces are noted. (Retain the plastic shift pattern insert).
3. On T-19 transmission inspect the knurled end of the
shift lever for undersize/oversize knurling by measuring the knurled diameter. The knurled diameter
should be between 37/64" and 19/32" in diameter. 4.
If the diameter of the knurled section is less than the specified 37/64" minimum, then the shift lever
should be replaced with a new one with good knurls. Also install a new shift ball with the new lever.
Figure 17
5. If the knurled diameter is within the specified diameter, replace the shift ball (7213) only, using
the original shift lever and shift ball insert.
NOTE: Before installing the shift ball on the transmission shift lever and, using a machinist file or
suitable hand grinder, file or grind a radius
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter M/T: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift
Lever Knob - Pulls Off > Page 448
or chamfer on the lever and the start of the knurls so as to remove the step from the top end of the
lever and (Figure 17, View A) to aid installation.
6. Install the shift lever ball by warming the ball with a heat gun to 140~ - 180~ and tapping the ball
onto the shift lever with a 7/16" socket and a rubber hammer or mallet. Tap the ball down to the
beginning of the taper below the knurled section as shown in Figure 17, View A. Install the shift pattern
insert. NOTE:
Tap the shift ball down on the shift lever to the beginning of the tapered shoulder (Figure 17, View
A) below the knurled section of the shift lever assembly.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E2TZ-7213-B Shift Ball B
E2TZ-7210-D Shift Lever T-18 R
E3TZ-7210-N Shift Lever T-19 C
E2TZ-7210-C Shift Lever NPG435 B
E2TZ-7210-L Shift Lever SROD R
E2TZ-7210-E Shift Lever M4OD R
E3TZ-7210-A Shift Lever TK 4 spd. C
E4TZ-7210-C Shift Lever TK 5 spd.* C
E2TZ-7210-B Shift Lever NP208/W1345 C
E3TZ-7210-K Shift Lever W-1350 C
* - Shift lever assembly includes shift tower.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 82-7-17 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION/TIME: Refer to the Labor Time
Standards Manual for applicable operation and time. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 7213 or 7210
Code:
01 or 16 as applicable.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob - Pulls
Off
Shifter Transfer Case: Customer Interest Shift Lever Knob - Pulls Off
Article No. 83-19-17
TRANSMISSION/TRANSFER CASES - SHIFT KNOB - PULLS OFF FLOOR SHIFT LEVER
LIGHT TRUCKS 1982-84 ALL MODEL LIGHT TRUCKS
Figure 17
Shift lever knob "pull-off" may be due to knob damage during installation or lever knurling which is
out of specification. The following procedure is to identify the cause and to service the condition
(See Figure 17).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob - Pulls
Off > Page 458
1. Remove the shift ball from the shift lever assembly by removing the plastic shift pattern insert
from the shift ball. Knock the ball off the lever with a block of wood and a hammer.
2. Inspect the lower cavity of the shift ball for broken or missing sections. Discard the ball if broken
or missing pieces are noted. (Retain the plastic shift pattern insert).
3. On T-19 transmission inspect the knurled end of the
shift lever for undersize/oversize knurling by measuring the knurled diameter. The knurled diameter
should be between 37/64" and 19/32" in diameter. 4.
If the diameter of the knurled section is less than the specified 37/64" minimum, then the shift lever
should be replaced with a new one with good knurls. Also install a new shift ball with the new lever.
Figure 17
5. If the knurled diameter is within the specified diameter, replace the shift ball (7213) only, using
the original shift lever and shift ball insert.
NOTE: Before installing the shift ball on the transmission shift lever and, using a machinist file or
suitable hand grinder, file or grind a radius
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever Knob - Pulls
Off > Page 459
or chamfer on the lever and the start of the knurls so as to remove the step from the top end of the
lever and (Figure 17, View A) to aid installation.
6. Install the shift lever ball by warming the ball with a heat gun to 140~ - 180~ and tapping the ball
onto the shift lever with a 7/16" socket and a rubber hammer or mallet. Tap the ball down to the
beginning of the taper below the knurled section as shown in Figure 17, View A. Install the shift pattern
insert. NOTE:
Tap the shift ball down on the shift lever to the beginning of the tapered shoulder (Figure 17, View
A) below the knurled section of the shift lever assembly.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E2TZ-7213-B Shift Ball B
E2TZ-7210-D Shift Lever T-18 R
E3TZ-7210-N Shift Lever T-19 C
E2TZ-7210-C Shift Lever NPG435 B
E2TZ-7210-L Shift Lever SROD R
E2TZ-7210-E Shift Lever M4OD R
E3TZ-7210-A Shift Lever TK 4 spd. C
E4TZ-7210-C Shift Lever TK 5 spd.* C
E2TZ-7210-B Shift Lever NP208/W1345 C
E3TZ-7210-K Shift Lever W-1350 C
* - Shift lever assembly includes shift tower.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 82-7-17 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION/TIME: Refer to the Labor Time
Standards Manual for applicable operation and time. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 7213 or 7210
Code:
01 or 16 as applicable.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever
Knob - Pulls Off
Shifter Transfer Case: All Technical Service Bulletins Shift Lever Knob - Pulls Off
Article No. 83-19-17
TRANSMISSION/TRANSFER CASES - SHIFT KNOB - PULLS OFF FLOOR SHIFT LEVER
LIGHT TRUCKS 1982-84 ALL MODEL LIGHT TRUCKS
Figure 17
Shift lever knob "pull-off" may be due to knob damage during installation or lever knurling which is
out of specification. The following procedure is to identify the cause and to service the condition
(See Figure 17).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever
Knob - Pulls Off > Page 465
1. Remove the shift ball from the shift lever assembly by removing the plastic shift pattern insert
from the shift ball. Knock the ball off the lever with a block of wood and a hammer.
2. Inspect the lower cavity of the shift ball for broken or missing sections. Discard the ball if broken
or missing pieces are noted. (Retain the plastic shift pattern insert).
3. On T-19 transmission inspect the knurled end of the
shift lever for undersize/oversize knurling by measuring the knurled diameter. The knurled diameter
should be between 37/64" and 19/32" in diameter. 4.
If the diameter of the knurled section is less than the specified 37/64" minimum, then the shift lever
should be replaced with a new one with good knurls. Also install a new shift ball with the new lever.
Figure 17
5. If the knurled diameter is within the specified diameter, replace the shift ball (7213) only, using
the original shift lever and shift ball insert.
NOTE: Before installing the shift ball on the transmission shift lever and, using a machinist file or
suitable hand grinder, file or grind a radius
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shifter Transfer Case: > 831917 > Sep > 83 > Shift Lever
Knob - Pulls Off > Page 466
or chamfer on the lever and the start of the knurls so as to remove the step from the top end of the
lever and (Figure 17, View A) to aid installation.
6. Install the shift lever ball by warming the ball with a heat gun to 140~ - 180~ and tapping the ball
onto the shift lever with a 7/16" socket and a rubber hammer or mallet. Tap the ball down to the
beginning of the taper below the knurled section as shown in Figure 17, View A. Install the shift pattern
insert. NOTE:
Tap the shift ball down on the shift lever to the beginning of the tapered shoulder (Figure 17, View
A) below the knurled section of the shift lever assembly.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E2TZ-7213-B Shift Ball B
E2TZ-7210-D Shift Lever T-18 R
E3TZ-7210-N Shift Lever T-19 C
E2TZ-7210-C Shift Lever NPG435 B
E2TZ-7210-L Shift Lever SROD R
E2TZ-7210-E Shift Lever M4OD R
E3TZ-7210-A Shift Lever TK 4 spd. C
E4TZ-7210-C Shift Lever TK 5 spd.* C
E2TZ-7210-B Shift Lever NP208/W1345 C
E3TZ-7210-K Shift Lever W-1350 C
* - Shift lever assembly includes shift tower.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 82-7-17 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION/TIME: Refer to the Labor Time
Standards Manual for applicable operation and time. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 7213 or 7210
Code:
01 or 16 as applicable.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > System Information > System
Diagnosis
Transmission Control Systems: Testing and Inspection
For Transmission Control Systems Diagnosis, go to Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brake Master Cylinder - Rebuilding Procedure
Brake Master Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brake Master Cylinder - Rebuilding Procedure
Article No. 83-19-14
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDERS - REBUILDING PROCEDURE
LIGHT TRUCKS 1981-84 ALL LIGHT TRUCKS
Rebuilding of brake master cylinders during the vehicle warranty period for the subject vehicles has
been authorized. Service kits (Base Part Number 2004) are now available for all light truck series
vehicles. The following procedure is recommended for rebuilding:
DISASSEMBLY
1. Clean the outside of the master cylinder and remove the filler cover and diaphragm. Drain and
discard any brake fluid that remains in the cylinder.
2. Depress the primary piston and remove snap ring from retaining groove at the rear of the master
cylinder bore.
3. Remove primary piston assembly from the master cylinder bore and inspect for seal damage or
twisting. Record condition of piston assembly on service order and discard assembly.
4. Remove the secondary piston assembly by directing compressed air into the outlet port at the
blind end of the bore while plugging the other outlet port. Inspect for seal damage or twisting.
Record condition of piston assembly on service order and discard assembly.
5. Inspect the master cylinder bore for signs of etching, pitting, scoring or other damage.
a. If bore is damaged, discard and replace with new master cylinder assembly. Do not attempt to
hone bore.
b. If bore is not damaged, rebuild master cylinder assembly using the proper service kit and the
procedure outlined below.
ASSEMBLY
1. Clean the master cylinder body with clean isopropyl alcohol to remove any contamination.
2. Dip the service kit piston assemblies in clean brake fluid (ESA-M6C25-A) to lubricate seals.
3. Carefully insert the complete secondary piston assembly in the master cylinder bore.
4. Carefully insert the primary piston assembly in the master cylinder bore.
5. Depress the primary piston and install the snap ring in the cylinder bore groove.
6. On manual brake vehicles, install the push rod retainer onto the push rod and install into the
primary piston. Make sure the retainer is properly seated and holding the push rod securely.
7. Install the cover and gasket on the master cylinder assembly and secure into position with the
retainer.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 80-21-14 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION/TIME: Refer to the Labor Time
Standards Manual for applicable operation and time. DLR. CODING: Basic Part No. 2004 Code: 53
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Rectifier Diode / Bridge, Alternator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Alternator - Rectifier Bench Test Procedure
Rectifier Diode / Bridge: Technical Service Bulletins Alternator - Rectifier Bench Test Procedure
Article No. 84-3-5
ALTERNATOR - RECTIFIER BENCH TEST PROCEDURE
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCKS ALL
During a recent dealer survey, it was discovered that some technicians are using digital meters for
alternator testing, despite specific instructions in the Shop Manual to the contrary. The digital
meters cannot be used for checking rectifier assemblies or diodes in the alternator. This may
explain a portion of non-defective rectifiers returned under warranty.
Alternator Rectifier Testing Information
The use of digital meters when bench testing an alternator rectifier assembly can cause
misdiagnosis. It is recommended in the Shop Manual (Section 31) that a Rotunda Meter Model
#059-00003, or equivalent, be used. Equivalent test meters must be of the "analog" type, not
digital. A digital meter could only be used if it has a diode checking function. However, the readings
should be compared with those of a new part to confirm the results.
If the rectifier is found to be okay, check for possible pinched or grounded wires to the inside of the
housing. Then reassemble the alternator with the tested rectifier. The Shop Manual Charging
System Diagnostic Procedure should be reviewed to confirm proper procedures were used.
Remember to first check for proper drive belt tension and proper wire connections at the alternator
and voltage regulator.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views
Ignition Lock: Connector Views
For Connector Views, please refer to: Ignition Switch/Diagrams,
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views > Page 488
Ignition Lock: Electrical Diagrams
For Wiring Diagrams, please refer to: Starting System/Diagrams,
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Starter - Motor Current Draw Revision
Starter Motor: Technical Service Bulletins Starter - Motor Current Draw Revision
Article No. 85-9-39
START - MOTOR CURRENT DRAW
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
The 1985 Light Truck Specification Book incorrectly states the starter motor current draw under
normal conditions as 50-180 Amps (page 334). The Specification Book should state that the starter
motor current draw under normal conditions should be 125 to 200 Amps.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary
Technical Service Bulletin # TECGLOS Date: 890503
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary
TECGLOS890503 DATE 05/03/89
TYPICAL ELECTRICAL COMPONENT SYMBOLS
TECHNICIAN'S GLOSSARY
This package contains a listing and explanation of Electrical/Electronic and Fuel Induction terms
and components found in Ford Service and Training Publications. It is intended to be used as a
quick reference and aid by technicians who service Ford built vehicles.
(ELECTRICAL/ELECTRONIC AND FUEL INDUCTION)
A
AC - Abbreviation for alternating current.
ACTIVE CIRCUIT - A circuit consisting of some active (semiconductor) elements.
ACTIVE SENSOR - A sensor in which the output is taken directly from the sensor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 497
ACTUATOR - A device which delivers motion in response to an electric signal.
ACTUATOR CABLE - In a speed control system, the cable responsible for transferring movement
of the vacuum diaphragm in the servo to the throttle plates.
ADDRESS - A specific memory location. A microprocessor (or CPU) sends information to a specific
address, or reads information from an address.
AC/DC WAVEFORMS
ALTERNATING CURRENT (AC) - Electrical flow that periodically reverses direction; two flows of
current, from positive to negative, one in each direction, are called a "cycle." Abbreviation is AC.
ALTERNATOR - Belt-driven electrical generator on the engine that produces a flow of alternating
current and converts it to direct current. The current produced by the alternator is stored in the
battery and used to supply all electrical needs of the vehicle.
AMMETER - A device that measures the flow of electrical current in a circuit; readings are given in
"amperes"
AMPERAGE - The amount of electrical current flowing in a circuit as read in amperes.
AMPERE - A unit measurement for the flow of electric current; 1 ampere flowing at 1 volt equals 1
watt of power.
AMPERE HOUR CAPACITY - A figure indicating the capacity of a storage battery in that it will
provide a certain amount of amperes over a certain number of hours.
AMPLIFIER - (1) A circuit or device used to increase the voltage or current of a signal. (2) In a
speed control system the solid state device that controls the operation of the system. Not used in
IVSC system.
AMPLIFY - To build up the strength of a signal.
ANALOG - A continuously variable voltage signal.
ANALOG - DIGITAL CONVERTER (A/D CONVERTER) - A circuit within the signal processing
section of the ECA that takes an analog and converts it to a digital signal to be used in the
microprocessor.
ANALOG METER - A meter that uses a needle to point to a number on a scale of numbers, usually
of the low impedance type.
AND GATE - A type of logic circuit that requires all inputs to be YES in order for the output to be
YES. ANTENNA ISOLATOR/AMPLIFIER - Device used on vehicles that utilize a combination
antenna/rear window defroster. It amplifies radio signals from the rear defroster/antenna grid. It
also provides power to the defroster grid.
ARCING - (1) Electrical spark jumping from one electrode to another, as in a spark plug. (2) The
occurrence of undesired sparking between electrical conductors or between a conductor and
ground when insulation is damaged or inadequate.
AUXILIARY WARNING MODULE - Module used on the Merkur Scorpio which controls the
operation of the auxiliary warning system.
B
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 498
B + - Abbreviation for the positive side of the power source.
BASE - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor, usually where an input signal is applied.
BATTERY - A device which converts chemical energy into electrical energy. A group of complete
electrical cells assembled in one housing or case.
BATTERY ACID - A solution of sulfuric acid used as the electrolyte in automotive storage batteries.
BENDIX DRIVE - A starter drive system design used to engage the starter motor shaft with the
gear teeth on the flywheel. Disengages automatically when the engine starts.
BIAS - Term used to indicate a certain voltage operating position or range.
BINARY - A number system using two digits - 0 and 1.
BLOCK DIAGRAM - A simplified schematic diagram made up of boxes labeled with the circuit
functions.
BRUSH - A pad of electrically conductive material that bears on the commutator to provide an
electrical circuit between rotating and stationary components. See also "commutator" BULB
OUTAGE MODULE - Module used on the Merkur Scorpio which controls the lamp out warning
system.
C
CAPACITIVE DISCHARGE - Ignition system in which primary power is stored in a capacitor;
ignition spark is created by discharge of the capacitor. Also called "capacitor discharge."
CAPACITOR - Electrical storage component also known as a "condensor" which acts as an
electrical sponge. Wired across the distributor's breaker points, a capacitor absorbs electricity
when points open, discharges it when they close. Capacitors are also used to suppress radio
interference.
CATHODE - Negative pole of an electric current.
CHARGE (or Recharge) - Passing an electrical current through a battery to restore it to its proper
energy level.
CHIP - A miniaturized electronic circuit etched into a base of silicon.
CIRCUIT - A system through which electricity flows before it returns to its source (thus having
completed a circuit).
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CIRCUIT BREAKER - A mechanical device that opens contacts when an electric flow is excessive;
used in place of a fuse. When current flow returns to normal, the circuit breaker in a car closes.
CLOCK SIGNAL - Continuous series of pulses at a constant frequency. CLOSED CIRCUIT - A
circuit which is uninterrupted from the current source and back to the current source.
CLOSED LOOP - A system that feeds back its output to the input side of electronic control
assembly which monitors the output and makes corrections as necessary.
COAST - A speed control operating mode where the system is deactivated to reduce speed by
pressing the COAST button. Once the COAST button is released, speed control is set at the speed
that the vehicle is currently travelling. If the vehicle speed is reduced below approximately 30 mph
(48 km/h), the operator must manually increase the speed and reset the system.
COIL - An assembly of two wire coils in a transformer that steps up low-voltage current to the high
levels needed to produce an ignition spark.
COIL SECONDARY - Refer to "Secondary Circuit".
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 499
COLD CRANKING RATE - A rating for automotive batteries in a 30-sec discharge test; measured
in amperes at either 0~F or -20~F.
COLLECTOR - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor, usually where the output signal
is taken from.
COMMUTATOR - A slotted metal ring on the end of the rotor of a generator or electric motor.
When in contact with stationary brushes, segments of the commutator conduct electricity to or from
the turning rotor.
COMPUTER - A device that takes information, processes it, makes decisions and outputs those
decisions.
CONDENSER - See "Capacitor."
CONDUCTOR - A material, normally metallic, that permits easy passage of heat or electricity.
CURRENT - A flow of electricity. Under the Electron Theory, flow is from negative to positive poles.
Under the Conventional Theory, flow is from positive to negative. CURRENT LIMITING - A function
usually done in the electronic control unit that allows B + to be connected to the sensor without
short circuiting.
D
DARLINGTON - A two-transistor switch with transistors connected so that their collectors are
common and their gains multiplied.
DATA OUTPUT LINK (DOL) - Fuel calculation data from the EEC-IV processor to the electronic trip
minder.
DC - Abbreviation for direct current.
DE-ENERGIZED - Having the electric current or energy source turned off.
DIGITAL - A signal that has two states: ON or OFF.
DIGITAL AUDIO DISC SYSTEM - Sound system that incorporates a compact audio disc player.
The player picks up audio signals digitally encoded on the disc through a laser beam.
DIGITAL METER - A meter that uses a numerical display in place of a needle and is usually of the
high impedance type.
DIMMER SWITCH - Handor foot-operated switch that turns the high-beam filaments of headlights
on or off.
DIODE - Electrical device that permits current to flow in only one direction. Most often used as a
component in electronic controls and accessories. Also converts the output of an alternator from
AC to DC.
DIRECT CURRENT (DC) - Electric current flowing in one direction.
DISABLE - A type of microcomputer decision which results in an automotive system being
deactivated and not permitted to operate.
DISCHARGE - Term describing the flow of electric current from a battery. Opposite of charge.
DISPLAY - An output device used to display information. DISTRIBUTOR CAM - A shaft which is
geared to the camshaft on the bottom, and has lobes on the top which open and close the breaker
points. The rotor is also mounted on the top of this shaft just past the lobes.
DRIVER - A transistor in the output control area of the ECA that is used to turn on and off various
actuators.
DUTY CYCLE SIGNAL - A type of square-wave signal that does not have a constant on and off
time.
DURASPARK II - A breakerless, solid state ignition system introduced in 1978. DURASPARK II
used a module and coil similar to the earlier Solid State Ignition (SSI) system except for calibration.
This system incorporated an adapter on the distributor to accommodate the large distributor
terminal housing and larger rotor required for use with the higher voltage breakerless system. In
addition, spark plug wire diameter was increased to 8 mm and improved silicone jacketing was
incorporated.
E
EARTH - Term referring to a ground.
ECA - Electronic Control Assembly
E-CELL - A cell which deplates material from the anode to the cathode as a current in the
microampere range is passed through it. When the anode is completely deplated, the E-cell
becomes open which turns on a three stage transistor to switch a signal output.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 500
ELECTRODE - Posts or plates which have an electrical potential with respect to each other, such
as in a spark plug or battery. Electrodes are either positive or negative.
ELECTROLYTE - Active chemical filler in a battery.
ELECTROMAGNETIC - Refers to a device which incorporates both electronic and magnetic
principles together in its operation.
ELECTROMECHANICAL - Refers to a device which incorporates both electronic and mechanical
principles together in its operation. ELECTROMECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER Instrument cluster, first introduced on Taurus/Sable models, that utilizes magnetic gauges and an
"overlapping subassemblies" design. Use of the "overlapping sub-assemblies" design eases
service because individual gauge sub-assemblies can be removed as individual pieces.
ELECTRON - Negatively charged portion of an atom that orbits around the nucleus of the atom.
ELECTRONIC - An operation, produced or caused by the action of electrons or by devices which
function as a result of electron action. Electronic is often used to describe the control of systems or
devices by the use of small electrical signals and various semiconductor devices and circuits.
EMF - Electromotive force or voltage.
EMITTER - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor that emits the electrons that the
collector collects.
ENABLE - A type of microcomputer decision which results in an automotive system being activated
and permitted to operate.
ENERGIZED - Having the electrical current or electrical source turned on.
F
FAILURE MODE EFFECTS MANAGEMENT (FMEM) STRATEGY - EEC IV strategy designed to
reduce the adverse effects that may be caused by an EEC system sensor failure. Should a sensor
fail, the ECA substitutes a good sensor signal in its place. This allows the engine to keep running
so that the vehicle can be driven to the dealer for service.
FIELD (A/C) - A coil with many turns of wire located behind the clutch rotor. Current passing
through this coil sets up a magnetic field and causes the clutch to engage. FIELD - Magnetic lines
of force orientated from north to south as in a magnetic field. A magnetic field may be natural as
with a permanent magnet or created when electricity flows in a wire.
FIELD COIL - A coil of insulated wire usually wound around an iron core. Current flowing in the coil
produces a magnetic field. Also called "field winding." FILAMENT - A resistance in a light bulb
which glows and produces light when a current is forced through it.
FIRING LINE
FIRING LINE - The total amount of voltage being expended through the secondary circuit. FLUX Electric or magnetic lines of force passing or flowing in a magnetic field. Also, material used to
cause joining metal to adhere to both parts to be joined.
FOUR-WAY FLASHERS - See "hazard warning system."
FREE ELECTRON - Electrons that are not bound to a certain atom but are free to move around
from atom to atom.
FREQUENCY - Refers to the number of times something repeats itself (such as a signal from a
sensor) in one second.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 501
FUEL PUMP MONITOR (FPM) - Input used to monitor the fuel pump secondary circuit.
FUEL PUMP RELAY (FP) - Relay or its control line. Relay is controlled by ECA processor.
Supplies power to electric fuel pump of EFI/CFI system. FUSE - A metal link in a circuit that melts
when the current flow is excessive, thereby breaking the circuit.
FUSE BLOCK - An assembly concentrating most or all of a car's fuses at one point.
FUSIBLE LINK - A wire or bar designed to melt if more than a certain amount of electrical current is
transmitted through it. Often used as a main fuse or backup fuse for large sectional portions of a
car's electrical system.
G
GAIN - A comparison of an input signal level to an output signal level.
GASSING - The venting of hydrogen bubbles from battery acid as the battery is recharged.
GENERATOR - An electromechanical device that converts mechanical power into direct current
electricity.
GLOW PLUG IN CYLINDER HEAD
GLOW PLUG - An assembly that resembles spark plug but with a heating element instead of
electrodes. Used at the beginning of the starting cycle in a diesel engine to aid compression
ignition. Sometimes spelled "glo plug" GND (or Ground) - Common line for all vehicle power,
vehicle chassis ground and engine block ground, connected to vehicle battery negative terminal.
GROUND - The negatively charged side of a circuit. A ground can be a wire, the negative side of
the battery or even the vehicle chassis. The ground circuit must be at least the same size or bigger
than the positive (hot) wire.
GROUND CIRCUIT - The return side of an electric circuit. Usually the frame, body or engine of a
single-wire automotive system.
GROUNDING - Connecting one side of a car's electric circuit to the chassis, body, or engine.
These parts then provide a metal path that conducts electrical current back to the car's battery to
complete a circuit. Grounding may be done with a jumper wire.
GROUP - A set of battery plates, either positive or negative, joined together but not assembled with
separators.
GROWLER - An electrical device for testing electric motor or generator armatures for shorts.
H
HALF-WAVE - A pulsating DC produced by rectifying AC.
HALL-EFFECT - The "Hall Effect" is a process where current is passed through a small slice of
semi-conductor material at the same time as a magnetic field to produce a small voltage in the
semi-conductor.
HARD SOLDER - Uniting two pieces of metal with material having a melting point higher than "soft"
solder. Example: silver soldering. HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM - Electrical switching device and
associated lights (usually the front and rear turn-signal lights) producing flashes of light to indicate
that a car is in a distress situation. Also called "emergency flashers" or "fourway flashers".
HEAT RANGE - A classification for spark plugs. The higher the number, the "hotter" the plug runs,
which means that the plug does not dissipate heat as quickly as a "cooler" plug does.
HEAT SINK - Metal bracket in end frame of alternator that contains and absorbs heat from diodes.
HIGH TENSION - Secondary or induced high voltage electrical current. Circuit includes wiring fron.
ignition distributor cap to coil and to each spark
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 502
plug.
HIGH TENSION SECONDARY VOLTAGE - Voltage which enables current to jump the spark plug
gap. This voltage is caused by the collapse of the magnetic field around the coil secondary
windings.
HOLE - A moveable vacancy which acts as a positive charge in a semi-conductor.
HORN RELAY - Electromagnetic circuit-closing device that switches electricity to the horn when
the horn button is depressed.
HOT LEAD - A wire, or conductor, in the hot or power circuit.
HYDROMETER - An instrument used to measure the specific gravity of liquids. Hydrometers can
be calibrated to indicate the charge level of a battery or the percentage of antifreeze in a coolant
mixture.
I
IDENTIFICATION CODE - A single digit, selftest service code, output at the beginning of the
"engine running" test which is equal to one-half of the number of engine cylinders.
IGNITION RESERVE - The differential between available voltage and the required voltage.
IGNITION SWITCH - Key-operated main power switch in a car. Its chief function is to close the
primary ignition circuit, but modern designs include several other circuits and even a steering
column lock.
IGNITION SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM - All the components that together produce the ignition spark: battery,
distributor, ignition coil, spark plugs and associated switches and wiring. IMAGE LINE - The
electronic picture tracing as seen on the screen of an oscilloscope.
IMPEDANCE - A form of opposition to AC current flow (resistance) measured in OHMS.
INDUCTION - The spontaneous creation of an electric current in a coil as it passes through a
magnetic field.
INERTIA SWITCH - A switch in the fuel pump circuit which shuts off power to the fuel pump in the
event the vehicle is involved in a collision. This switch must be manually reset.
INPUT - Information provided to a microcomputer to allow accurate control of a system.
INPUT CONDITIONER - A device or circuit that conditions or prepares an input signal for use by a
microcomputer. INSULATION - Materials which do not readily conduct electricity.
INSULATOR - A nonconducting substance or body, such as porcelain, glass, or bakelite used for
insulating wires in electrical circuits to prevent the leakage of electricity.
INTEGRAL RELAY CONTROL MODULE (IRCM) - A module which interfaces with the EEC-IV
processor to provide control of the cooling fan, A/C clutch and fuel pump. The module also
incorporates the EEC power relay to provide power to the EEC-IV system.
INTEGRATED CIRCUIT (IC) - A small semiconductor device that contains thousands of
component parts and is capable of doing many circuit functions. Also called "chips"
INTEGRATED VEHICLE SPEED CONTROL (IVSC) - A Ford speed control system which is
integrated with the on-board EEC TV engine control system. This system does not require an
amplifier because all computer control is through the EEC IV processor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 503
INVERTERA - A circuit that takes an input and converts it to the opposite state in the output.
J
JUICE - A slang term for electricity.
K
KILOWATT - A measurement of power equal to 1,000 watts. 100 volts flowing at the rate of 10
amperes equals 1 kilowatt. Abbreviation is kw or KW.
KILOWATT HOUR - The work accomplished by an agent operating at a power level of a kilowatt
for one hour. 1kw. hr. = 1,000 watts x 3,600 seconds or 3,600,000 watt seconds. kw or KW Abbreviation for kilowatt.
L
LEAD - (1) An elemental metal that is heavy, pliable and easily melted. (2) Abbreviated term for
tetraethyl lead. (3) A wire conductor.
LEAD SULFATE - A product of the electrochemical action in a lead-acid battery. The sulfate
deposit forms on the plates and slowly fouls the battery.
LIGHT-EMITTING DIODE (LED) - A positivenegative junction of crystal material, housed in a
dome-shaped housing, which produces light when forward bias current is applied.
LINEAR POTENTIOMETER - A variable resistance whose resistance changes in direct proportion
to the travel of the moveable terminal.
LOAD - An electrical device connected into a circuit to provide a resistance and control the rate of
current rate.
LOAD TEST - (1) A test for starter motors in which the current draw is measured while the engine
is cranking. (2) A battery test.
LOGIC GATE - A circuit that will give an output when certain inputs are present.
LOW FREQUENCY OSCILLATIONS - The long-tracing vertical image lines which are seen in the
coil section.
M
MAGNET - Any body with the property of attracting iron or steel.
MAGNETIC FIELD - The area surrounding the poles of a magnet which is affected by its attraction
or repulsion forces.
MAGNETIC GAUGE - Special type of instrument gauge, used in the electro-mechanical instrument
cluster, that accurately show values even when the ignition is off.
MAGNETIC PICKUP COIL - Coil used in the distributor of the breakerless solid state ignition
systems to determine exactly when to switch off the coil secondary. MAGNETIC RELUCTANCE The resistance of a magnetic path to the flow of magnetic flux lines through it.
MAGNETIC SWITCH - A switch operated by a small electromagnet. Solenoids and relays are
magnetic switches.
MAGNETO - A type of generator used in early vehicles which produced an extremely high voltage
spark.
MICROCOMPUTER - A device that takes information, processes it, makes decisions and outputs
those decisions. Microcomputers are generally small and portable, and are located inside a
processor.
MICROPROCESSOR - A small processor contained within the on-board computer (processor).
MINIMUM SPEED LOCKOUT (MSLO) - An additional safety feature added to Ford speed control
systems that prevents speed control operation at very low speeds.
MODULE - A control assembly. A module could be any package that is intended to perform a
specific task (such as ignition). Usually modules can be disconnected and replaced easily.
MOTOR - Electromechanical device that converts electricity into mechanical energy.
MULTIPLE FUNCTION WARNING INDICATOR - A warning indicator assembly, first introduced on
the 1987 Mustang GT that indicates low oil, low coolant, low fuel, and low washer conditions.
N
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 504
N-TYPE - A semi-conductor material that has an excess of free electrons.
NAND GATE - A type of logic device that requires all inputs to be YES in order for the output to be
NO.
NEGATIVE POLE - Point from which an electrical current flows as it passes through a circuit.
NO-LOAD TEST - A test for starter motors in which current draw is measured when the starter's
pinion gear is not engaged.
NOR GATE - A type of logic circuit that if either input is YES, the output is NO.
NORMALLY CLOSED - Refers to a switch or a solenoid that is closed when no control or force is
acting on it.
NORMALLY OPEN - Refers to a switch or solenoid that is open when no control or force is acting
on it.
NOT GATE - A type of logic circuit that has an inverted output; if the input is YES, the output is NO,
and vice versa.
NPN - A transistor with a P type base sandwiched between an N type emitter and collector.
O
OHM - A unit of electrical resistance opposing current flow. Resistance varies in different materials
and varies with temperature.
OHMMETER
OHMMETER - An instrument that measures electrical resistance of a conductor in units called
ohms. OHM'S LAW - A law of electricity which states the relationship between voltage, current and
resistance. It takes an electromotive force of one volt to force one ampere of current through one
ohm of resistance. Equation - volts = amperes x ohms (E = I x R)
ON DEMAND TEST - In Self-Test, the Key On/Engine Off and Engine Running positions, which are
technician initiated, are run from a program within the processor.
OPEN CIRCUIT - An electrical circuit that because of break or because a switch has failed to close
is not complete. See also "short circuit."
OPEN LOOP - A system that does not feed back its output to its input.
OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER - A device with two inputs and one output having a very high voltage
gain.
OPTIC SENSOR - A device that produces a voltage signal by using a light source, a light sensitive
material and a slotted wheel between the two.
OR GATE - A type of logic circuit that if either input is YES, the output is YES.
OSCILLATION - A rapid back-and-forth movement.
OSCILLOSCOPE - Instrument that converts voltage and frequency readings into traces on a
cathrode ray tube.
OUTPUT - Decisions or commands issued by a microcomputer to output devices to allow displays
and actuators to function.
OUTPUT CONTROL - Circuits inside of the ECA that are used to turn external devices on and off.
OUTPUT CYCLING CHECK (OCC) - A position of the end of the Key On/Engine Off test that
enables energizing and de-energizing the auxiliary output on demand.
OUTPUT DRIVER - A transistor in the output control area of the processor that is used to turn
various actuators on and off.
OUTPUT STATE CHECK - A test performed in the Key On/Engine Off mode after the continuous
codes have been sent which forces the processor to
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 505
activate some actuators for additional diagnostics.
OVERCHARGING - Continuing to charge a battery after it has a full charge; can damage the
battery.
P
P TYPE - A semi-conductor material that has holes or a lack of electrons.
PARALLEL CIRCUIT
PARALLEL - Electrical design in which two or more circuits, batteries or components share
common negative and positive connections. PASSIVE CIRCUIT - A circuit consisting of all passive
elements, resistors, capacitors or inductors. PASSIVE SENSOR - A sensor which modifies the
output of a voltage-divider network that the sensor is part of.
PERMEABLE - A characteristic of how good a material is as a magnetic path.
PHOTOELECTRIC CELL (PE) - A light sensitive material that changes variations of light into
varying voltage signals.
PHOTOTRANSISTOR - A light sensitive transistor that generates an output signal in proportion to
the light picked up.
PICKUP COIL
PICKUP COIL - An electromagnetic device in the distributor of the electronic ignition system. It
creates an electromagnetic field due to the permanent magnet that is part of the pickup assembly.
Then the magnetic field produces an a.c. signal to the control module, informing the module of the
turning position of the distributor shaft. PIEZOELECTRIC - Refers to an electronic device which is
capable of generating a voltage when subjected to mechanical pressure.
PLATE - (1) Component of a storage battery, one of a series of flat lead sheets with which acid
reacts to produce electricity. (2) A pivoting flap in the choke or throttle valve of a carburetor. (3) To
apply a coating or layer of one material over another.
PNP - A transistor with an N type base sandwiched between a P type emitter and collector. POINT
GAP - The space between the point contacts which is adjusted to provide the correct dwell.
POLARITY - The difference in properties or powers between two bodies or the ends of one body,
as in a magnet. According to the Current Theory, polarities in an electric circuit are established by
an excess of electrons on one side (negative) and a deficiency on the other (positive).
POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) HEATER - A heater system used on chokes
and on diesel fuel heaters. PTC heaters are self regulating because as their temperature rises so
too does the resistance limiting the amount of electrical flow and overall heating.
POSITIVE TERMINAL - That terminal in a circuit to which current flows.
POTENTIAL - Electrical force measured in volts. Sometimes used interchangeably with voltage.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 506
POTENTIAL DIFFERENCE - A difference of electrical pressure that sets up a flow of electric
current.
POTENTIAL DROP - A loss of electrical pressure due to resistance.
POTENTIOMETER
POTENTIOMETER (POT) - A variable resistor with three connections. The third connection (wiper)
moves physically up and down the resistive element which has each end attached to one of the
other two connections. PRIMARY - (1) A low-voltage circuit or part of a circuit. (2) The input coil of
a transformer. PRIMARY WINDING - Low voltage winding of the coil which is electronically
connected to its secondary only by the magnetic field they share. When the primary winding is
connected across, a potential current flows through it, building a magnetic field around itself and
inducing a voltage in the secondary. When disconnected, the cease in current through the primary
again induces a voltage in the secondary which is used to ignite the air/fuel mixture.
PRINTED CIRCUIT - Electrically conductive metal paths that are produced by printing a pattern on
a board, then etching away all areas that are not printed.
PROCESSOR - A metal housing which contains a microcomputer and other components used in
providing electronic system control. The Electronic Control Assembly (ECA) is often referred to as
the processor.
PROGRAM - A set of detailed instructions which a microcomputer follows when controlling a
system.
PULSE - An abrupt change in voltage whether positive or negative.
PULSE WIDTH - The length of time an actuator, such as a fuel injector, remains energized.
Q
QUARTZ-HALOGEN HEADLIGHT - A modern headlight design that produces a much brighter,
whiter light than the conventional tungsten-filament light. The bulb is made of, quartz, rather than
glass, and is filled with a halogen gas. Also called "halogen headlight."
R
RANDOM ACCESS MEMORY (RAM) - A type of memory which is used to store information
temporarily. Information can be written to and read from RAM.
READ - A microcomputer operation where information is retrieved from memory.
READ ONLY MEMORY (ROM) - A type of memory which is used to store information permanently.
Information can not be written to ROM; as the name implies, information can only be read from
ROM.
READOUT CONTROL - Circuits inside of the ECA that are used for operating digital instrument
displays.
RECHARGE - (1) To restore energy to a battery by means of an electric current. (2) To restore the
level of a substance in a system, as recharging an air conditioner with refrigerant.
RECTIFIER (diode) - Electrical device that permits alternating current to flow in only one direction
thereby transforming it into direct current.
REDUNDANT BRAKE SHUTOFF - A safety feature of Ford speed control systems that shuts the
speed control system off if there is a 10-15 mph drop in speed.
REFERENCE VOLTAGE (VREF) - Power supplied by the ECA to some sensors that are regulated
at a specific voltage.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 507
STARTER RELAY
RELAY - An electromagnetic switching device using low current to open or close a high-current
circuit. RELUCTANCE - The resistance of a material to the flow of magnetic lines of force.
REQUIRED VOLTAGE - Voltage necessary to overcome the resistance of the secondary circuit
and establish a spark to the ground electrode of the spark plug.
RESERVE CAPACITY - The length of time that a fully charged battery at 80~F will remain
functional when it is discharging at a rate of 25 amps. This rating is intended to tell the driver how
long the car can be operated with headlights and certain other accessories on after an alternator
failure.
RESIDUAL MAGNETISM - Slight magnetic properties retained by metal, such as a wiring coil in a
generator, after it has passed through a magnetic field.
RESISTANCE - The opposition offered by a conductor to a flow of electricity; measured in ohms.
RESISTOR - A device installed in an electrical circuit which tends to prevent or reduce the flow of
current.
RESUME - An operating mode of the speed control system which reactivates the system after it
has been disabled (such as by stepping on the brake or clutch pedal) and returns it to the speed at
which it was previously set. Shutting the vehicle off erases the resume memory.
RHEOSTAT - A device for regulating a current by means of a variable resistance.
ROTOR
ROTOR - The rotating part of a distributor that transfers current from the coil cable to the spark
plug cables.
S
SAMPLING - The act of periodically collecting or sending information. A microcomputer samples
input from various sensors in the process of controlling a system. SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM Symbolic representation of an electric circuit or vacuumhose circuit.
SEALED-BEAM - Headlight design incorporating filaments, reflector, and a lens in a unit with no
separate bulb.
SECONDARY - (1) A high-voltage circuit or part of a circuit. (2) The output coil of a transformer.
SECONDARY CIRCUIT - The high voltage part of the ignition system which extends from the
center tower of the coil all the way down to and across the spark plug gap.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 508
SECONDARY INSULATION (SPARK PLUG WIRE)
SECONDARY INSULATION - The material that contains the spark from the time it leaves the
center tower of the coil to the time it reaches the insulated electrode of the spark plug.
SECONDARY RESISTANCE - The resistance encountered by electricity as it travels on its route
from the center tower of the coil to the ground electrode of the spark plug.
SECONDARY WINDING - See "Secondary Circuit."
SEMICONDUCTOR - General term for transistors, integrated circuits, and other electronic devices
made of materials, such as silicone, that conduct electricity poorly.
SENSOR - Used as inputs to the ECA, a device that measures a condition and converts it into
some kind of electrical signal. SERIES - An electrical connection in which two or more circuits,
batteries or components are connected negative to positive. The opposite of "parallel."
SERVO - In a speed control system, a vacuum operated device controlled by the amplifier
responsible for changing the throttle plate settings in relationship to engine speed. The servo
contains solenoid valves for controlling vacuum to the diaphragm and a throttle position sensor
(servo in IVSC system does not contain throttle position sensor).
SET/ACCEL - In a speed control system, a driver control button that is responsible for setting a
speed. It can also be used to raise the speed by holding it down until the desired speed is reached.
SHIFT INDICATOR LIGHT (SIL) - A system primarily controlled by engine speed and manifold
vacuum which provides a visual indication to the driver of when to shift to the next higher gear to
obtain fuel economy.
SHORT CIRCUIT - Defect in an electric circuit in which electricity flows directly from one conductor
to another rather than through the intended circuit.
SHUNT - A conductor joining two points in a circuit so as to form a parallel circuit through which a
portion of the current may pass in order to regulate the amount of current flowing in the main
circuit.
SHUNT CIRCUIT - A minor side circuit that parallels and feeds off a main circuit.
SIGNAL - A voltage condition that transmits specific information in an electronic system.
SIGNAL PROCESSING - A general term used for conditioning input signals. It covers many
functions such as A/D converting, amplifying, counting, etc. It describes what happens to input
signals from the sensor on their way to the microprocessor.
SINE-WAVE - A voltage signal generated by a coil of wire, a magnetic field and movement
between them. SLIP RING - A circular conductor on a rotor or armature that contacts brushes.
Electricity flows from the brushes to the slip ring, thus allowing current to pass from a stationary
part to a rotating part.
SLOW CHARGE - The preferred method of administering a charge to a battery where current is
applied over a long period of time and at a low rate.
SOLENOID - A wire coil with a moveable core which changes position by means of
electromagnetism when current flows through the coil. Sometimes synonymous with "relay."
SOLENOID RELAY - A switching component in the starter motor circuit. Light current operates the
solenoid, which closes the contacts carrying the heavy current to the starter motor.
SOLENOID SWITCH - A switch operated by a solenoid.
SOLENOID VACUUM SWITCH - Any one of a variety of engine control devices that combine a
solenoid switch and a vacuum valve. The solenoid opens or closes a valve in a vacuum line,
usually as part of a pollution-control system.
SOLID STATE - General term for transistors and related electronic components that are replacing
vacuum tubes.
SOLID STATE IGNITION (SSI) - The ignition systems that used a transistor to switch the coil. One
used breaker points to switch on the transistor, the
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 509
other used the magnetic pickup coil. Both of these systems precede the Duraspark systems, but
the one that used the pickup coil is the same.
SPARK ADVANCE - Causing the ignition spark to occur earlier.
SPARK GAP - The space between the spark plugs center electrode and ground electrode. SPARK
LINE - The pattern that represents the time during which the air/fuel mixture is being burned within
the combustion chamber.
SPARK PLUG - Electrical component that produces a spark to ignite the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinders.
SPARK RETARD - Causing less spark advance to be added, resulting in an ignition spark
introduced later.
SPLICE - The joining of two or more conductors at a single point by crimping, soldering or brazing.
SQUARE-WAVE - A digital on-off type of signal that has a very fast rise and fall.
STARTER - The electric motor and drive mechanism used to start an engine.
STOPLAMP SWITCH - Switch responsible for disabling the speed control system when the brakes
are applied. Also responsible for operating the stoplamps when the brake pedal is depressed.
STORAGE CELLS - A cell which stores potential for electricity in the form of chemicals. Once
discharged it can be recharged by forcing current through it in the opposite direction. These cells,
when placed in series, form a storage battery.
STRATEGY - The programming of the ECA determining how it reacts under certain conditions.
Some currently used strategies are Failure Mode Effects Management (FMEM), Idle, Lean Cruise,
etc.
SWITCH - A device used to open, close or redirect the current in an electrical circuit.
T
TERMINAL - A device attached to the end of a wire or cable to make an electrical connection.
THERMISTOR - A resistor that changes its resistance with temperature.
THERMOCOUPLE - A thermoelectric device used to measure temperature accurately, especially
one consisting of two dissimilar metals joined together so that a potential difference is generated
between the points of contact. The amount of potential difference is a measure of the heat at the
point of contact of the two dissimilar metals.
THICK FILM IGNITION (TFI) -IV - Electronic ignition system utilizing a Hall-Effect sensor to switch
the ignition coil on and off through the ECA. The term "thick film" is Lised to describe the process
used to build the TFI circuit on the module. The basic circuit is placed on a layer of alumina.
Several layers of film are required to print the circuit - hence the name "thick film." The resistors
and connecting paths are part of the film. Other components such as capacitors, diodes, darlington
transistors and integrated circuits are added on top of the thick film or are attached to it. There are
two TFI systems, TFI-I used on 1982 1.6L engines, and TFI-II used on engines after 1983 with
EEC-IV. The TFI-IV ignition system uses no vacuum or centrifugal advance, all advance is
controlled by the ECA. TFII utilizes vacuum and centrifugal advance. Both TFI-I and IV use an
E-core coil instead of an oil filled coil.
THICK FILM IGNITION (TFI) MODULE - Smaller module which is mounted on the distributor and
fires the ignition coil.
THROUGHPUT - The flow of a voltage signal from input to output.
TIMER - A feature of microcomputers which allows the microcomputer to measure time intervals,
such as "time since engine start" or "time in neutral idle." TRANSDUCER - A device that changes
energy from one form to another. For example, a transducer is used to change the pulse of fuel
injection in a diesel to electricity so that timing can be checked. In automotive air-conditioning
controls used in automatic temperature systems, a transducer changes an electrical signal to a
vacuum signal, which operates mechanical doors.
TRANSFER HOSE - Hose on the speed control servo that connects either manifold vacuum or
atmospheric pressure to the sealed side of the diaphragm, depending on servo solenoid positions.
TRANSISTOR - A small solid-state electronic switching device which uses semiconductors. Widely
used to replace vacuum tubes and switches.
TRUTH TABLE - A chart that lists all of the possible combinations of inputs and the corresponding
outputs for a logic gate.
U
UNIVERSAL DISTRIBUTOR - Distributor which uses a PIP sensor instead of a CP sensor, and TFI
module instead of the Dura-Spark ignition module. This distributor can be used with EEC only.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 510
V
VACUUM DUMP VALVE - A valve that mechanically releases the vacuum from the servo when the
brake pedal is depressed.
VACUUM SOLENOID VALVE - An electrically operated vacuum on and off valve similar in
operation to a relay.
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR - Device mounted on the transmission or speedometer cable that is
responsible for monitoring vehicle speed and passing the information on to the speed control
amplifier or EEC IV module.
VOLT - The unit of measurement for the force or pressure of a flow of electricity.
VOLTAGE - The electrical pressure which causes current to flow in a circuit. VOLTAGE APPLIED The actual voltage read at a given point in a circuit. It equals the available voltage of the power
supply minus the losses in the circuit up to that point.
VOLTAGE AVAILABLE - The voltage delivered by the power supply (battery, alternator, generator,
etc.).
VOLTAGE DIVIDER - Two or more resistances connected in series form a voltage divider network.
When current flows the voltage divides itself across the resistances.
VOLTAGE DROP - A lowering of the voltage in a circuit when resistance, or electrical load, is
added.
VOLTAGE REGULATOR - An electrical device that prevents excessive voltage on, or overcharge
of, the battery by the generator or alternator.
VOLTMETER - An instrument used to measure the voltage in an electrical circuit.
VOLT-OHM-METER (VOM) - Combination meter used to measure voltage and resistance (ohms).
They are available in both analog (measures by needle movement) or digital (measures by a
numeric display). May be referred to as an AVOM (analog) or DVOM (digital).
VREF - Abbreviation for reference voltage.
W
WATT - A measurement of power. One volt multiplied by 1 amp equals 1 watt, and 746 watts equal
1 horsepower. One "kilowatt" equals 1,000 watts. WIGGLE TEST - Performed with either a
voltmeter or star tester while wiggling or tapping the system harness connectors.
WIPER - Refer to "potentiometer."
WIRING HARNESS - A bundle of insulated electrical wires covered by an additional insulating
jacket. The individual wires emerge from the harness at different points to go to various
components.
WRITE - A microcomputer operation where information is sent to and stored in memory.
X
X-NOR GATE - A logic circuit that requires both inputs to be the same for a YES output.
X-OR GATE - A logic circuit that requires both inputs to be the same for a NO output.
Z
ZENER DIODE - A two terminal device with 1 PN junction that can conduct in the reverse direction
when a certain voltage is reached.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 511
Power and Ground Distribution: Technical Service Bulletins Wire Harness Terminal and Connector
- Service Kit
WIRING-WIRE HARNESS TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR SERVICE KIT Article No. 89-19-5
FORD:
1990 and prior ALL FORD LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1990 and prior ALL LINCOLN-MERCURY LINES
MERKUR: 1990 and prior ALL MERKUR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1990 and prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1990 and prior ALL MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK LINES This TSB article is
being republished in its entirety to make dealers aware of availability of the wiring harness terminal
and connector repair kit.
ISSUE: A wire harness terminal and connector repair kit is available for repairing electrical wire
harnesses. This kit allows dealers to repair broken or corroded terminals and connectors instead of
replacing an entire wire harness. The kit is easy to use and allows the technician to perform a
professional looking repair in a short period of time.
ACTION: To purchase a wire harness terminal and connector repair kit, contact Altair International
Incorporated. Refer to the following information for ordering details.
ALTAIR INTERNATIONAL INC.
ATTN: SALES DEPARTMENT
22800 HALL ROAD
MT. CLEMENS, MI 48043
TELEPHONE: (313) 466-1200
An order form is included in the back of this TSB issue. To order:
^ Fill out the order form.
^ Enclose a check for the total amount. (This kit cannot be charged to your dealership parts code.)
^ Send the completed form and check to the ALTAIR INTERNATIONAL INC.
The kit consists of:
^ Two 50 drawer metal cabinets that contain 6 each of the 96 different terminals, machined
crimped with a four inch "pigtail" of 12 or 16 gauge wire.
^ A unique, high compression crimping tool that will make sure of a solid connection preventing
moisture or contaminants from affecting the wire splice.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: none SUPERSEDES:
88-17-5, Date 8/17/88
WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS CODES:
2770, 2700
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 512
Technical Service Bulletin # 87153 Date: 870729
Wiring - Circuit Number/Color Code Charts
WIRING - CORPORATE STANDARD CIRCUIT Article No.
NUMBER CHARTS FOR WIRE CIRCUIT NUMBER, 87-15-3
AND COLOR CODES
FORD: 1980-88 ALL CAR LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-88 ALL CAR LINES
MERKUR: 1985-88 XR4Ti 1988 SCORPIO
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-88 F SERIES, BRONCO 1983-88 RANGER 1984-88 BRONCO II 1986-88
AEROSTAR
ISSUE: The Standard Circuit Number Charts on pages 11 through 20 of this TSB are being printed
for your information. The electrical circuits are listed by number code with the description/name and
the matching color code as specified by Ford Corporate Standards. These charts are also printed
in the reference section of the Vacuum and Wiring Manual.
ACTION: When tracing circuits or trying to pinpoint individual circuits, use these charts with the
appropriate Shop Manual, EVTM (Electrical and Vacuum Troubleshooting Manual), or the Vacuum
and Wiring Manual.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Wiring Color Codes
The wire color code indicates the circuit number, color of the wire and the wire gauge size.
Where two colors are shown for a wire, the first color is the basic color of the wire. The second
color is the dot, hash, or stripe marking. If D or H is given, the second color is dots or hash marks.
If there is no letter after the second color, the wire has a stripe.
For example:
BR/O is a brown wire with an orange stripe.
R/Y D is a red wire with yellow dots.
BK/W H is a black wire with white hash marks.
Color Abbreviations
BL Blue N Natural
BK Black O Orange
BR Brown PK Pink
DB Dark Blue P Purple
DG Dark Green R Red
GR Green T Tan
GY Gray W White
LB Light Blue Y Yellow
LG Light Green
If a vehicle specific wire color in a connector does not match the diagram shown, it can usually be
identified by comparing the other colors shown at the wire connectors. Specific wire color
deviations in the manufacturing of a wire harness are usually for a short duration.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 513
WIRE TYPES
Standard Circuit Number Chart
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 514
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 515
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 516
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 517
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 518
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 519
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 520
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 521
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 522
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 523
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary
Technical Service Bulletin # TECGLOS Date: 890503
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary
TECGLOS890503 DATE 05/03/89
TYPICAL ELECTRICAL COMPONENT SYMBOLS
TECHNICIAN'S GLOSSARY
This package contains a listing and explanation of Electrical/Electronic and Fuel Induction terms
and components found in Ford Service and Training Publications. It is intended to be used as a
quick reference and aid by technicians who service Ford built vehicles.
(ELECTRICAL/ELECTRONIC AND FUEL INDUCTION)
A
AC - Abbreviation for alternating current.
ACTIVE CIRCUIT - A circuit consisting of some active (semiconductor) elements.
ACTIVE SENSOR - A sensor in which the output is taken directly from the sensor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 528
ACTUATOR - A device which delivers motion in response to an electric signal.
ACTUATOR CABLE - In a speed control system, the cable responsible for transferring movement
of the vacuum diaphragm in the servo to the throttle plates.
ADDRESS - A specific memory location. A microprocessor (or CPU) sends information to a specific
address, or reads information from an address.
AC/DC WAVEFORMS
ALTERNATING CURRENT (AC) - Electrical flow that periodically reverses direction; two flows of
current, from positive to negative, one in each direction, are called a "cycle." Abbreviation is AC.
ALTERNATOR - Belt-driven electrical generator on the engine that produces a flow of alternating
current and converts it to direct current. The current produced by the alternator is stored in the
battery and used to supply all electrical needs of the vehicle.
AMMETER - A device that measures the flow of electrical current in a circuit; readings are given in
"amperes"
AMPERAGE - The amount of electrical current flowing in a circuit as read in amperes.
AMPERE - A unit measurement for the flow of electric current; 1 ampere flowing at 1 volt equals 1
watt of power.
AMPERE HOUR CAPACITY - A figure indicating the capacity of a storage battery in that it will
provide a certain amount of amperes over a certain number of hours.
AMPLIFIER - (1) A circuit or device used to increase the voltage or current of a signal. (2) In a
speed control system the solid state device that controls the operation of the system. Not used in
IVSC system.
AMPLIFY - To build up the strength of a signal.
ANALOG - A continuously variable voltage signal.
ANALOG - DIGITAL CONVERTER (A/D CONVERTER) - A circuit within the signal processing
section of the ECA that takes an analog and converts it to a digital signal to be used in the
microprocessor.
ANALOG METER - A meter that uses a needle to point to a number on a scale of numbers, usually
of the low impedance type.
AND GATE - A type of logic circuit that requires all inputs to be YES in order for the output to be
YES. ANTENNA ISOLATOR/AMPLIFIER - Device used on vehicles that utilize a combination
antenna/rear window defroster. It amplifies radio signals from the rear defroster/antenna grid. It
also provides power to the defroster grid.
ARCING - (1) Electrical spark jumping from one electrode to another, as in a spark plug. (2) The
occurrence of undesired sparking between electrical conductors or between a conductor and
ground when insulation is damaged or inadequate.
AUXILIARY WARNING MODULE - Module used on the Merkur Scorpio which controls the
operation of the auxiliary warning system.
B
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 529
B + - Abbreviation for the positive side of the power source.
BASE - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor, usually where an input signal is applied.
BATTERY - A device which converts chemical energy into electrical energy. A group of complete
electrical cells assembled in one housing or case.
BATTERY ACID - A solution of sulfuric acid used as the electrolyte in automotive storage batteries.
BENDIX DRIVE - A starter drive system design used to engage the starter motor shaft with the
gear teeth on the flywheel. Disengages automatically when the engine starts.
BIAS - Term used to indicate a certain voltage operating position or range.
BINARY - A number system using two digits - 0 and 1.
BLOCK DIAGRAM - A simplified schematic diagram made up of boxes labeled with the circuit
functions.
BRUSH - A pad of electrically conductive material that bears on the commutator to provide an
electrical circuit between rotating and stationary components. See also "commutator" BULB
OUTAGE MODULE - Module used on the Merkur Scorpio which controls the lamp out warning
system.
C
CAPACITIVE DISCHARGE - Ignition system in which primary power is stored in a capacitor;
ignition spark is created by discharge of the capacitor. Also called "capacitor discharge."
CAPACITOR - Electrical storage component also known as a "condensor" which acts as an
electrical sponge. Wired across the distributor's breaker points, a capacitor absorbs electricity
when points open, discharges it when they close. Capacitors are also used to suppress radio
interference.
CATHODE - Negative pole of an electric current.
CHARGE (or Recharge) - Passing an electrical current through a battery to restore it to its proper
energy level.
CHIP - A miniaturized electronic circuit etched into a base of silicon.
CIRCUIT - A system through which electricity flows before it returns to its source (thus having
completed a circuit).
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CIRCUIT BREAKER - A mechanical device that opens contacts when an electric flow is excessive;
used in place of a fuse. When current flow returns to normal, the circuit breaker in a car closes.
CLOCK SIGNAL - Continuous series of pulses at a constant frequency. CLOSED CIRCUIT - A
circuit which is uninterrupted from the current source and back to the current source.
CLOSED LOOP - A system that feeds back its output to the input side of electronic control
assembly which monitors the output and makes corrections as necessary.
COAST - A speed control operating mode where the system is deactivated to reduce speed by
pressing the COAST button. Once the COAST button is released, speed control is set at the speed
that the vehicle is currently travelling. If the vehicle speed is reduced below approximately 30 mph
(48 km/h), the operator must manually increase the speed and reset the system.
COIL - An assembly of two wire coils in a transformer that steps up low-voltage current to the high
levels needed to produce an ignition spark.
COIL SECONDARY - Refer to "Secondary Circuit".
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 530
COLD CRANKING RATE - A rating for automotive batteries in a 30-sec discharge test; measured
in amperes at either 0~F or -20~F.
COLLECTOR - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor, usually where the output signal
is taken from.
COMMUTATOR - A slotted metal ring on the end of the rotor of a generator or electric motor.
When in contact with stationary brushes, segments of the commutator conduct electricity to or from
the turning rotor.
COMPUTER - A device that takes information, processes it, makes decisions and outputs those
decisions.
CONDENSER - See "Capacitor."
CONDUCTOR - A material, normally metallic, that permits easy passage of heat or electricity.
CURRENT - A flow of electricity. Under the Electron Theory, flow is from negative to positive poles.
Under the Conventional Theory, flow is from positive to negative. CURRENT LIMITING - A function
usually done in the electronic control unit that allows B + to be connected to the sensor without
short circuiting.
D
DARLINGTON - A two-transistor switch with transistors connected so that their collectors are
common and their gains multiplied.
DATA OUTPUT LINK (DOL) - Fuel calculation data from the EEC-IV processor to the electronic trip
minder.
DC - Abbreviation for direct current.
DE-ENERGIZED - Having the electric current or energy source turned off.
DIGITAL - A signal that has two states: ON or OFF.
DIGITAL AUDIO DISC SYSTEM - Sound system that incorporates a compact audio disc player.
The player picks up audio signals digitally encoded on the disc through a laser beam.
DIGITAL METER - A meter that uses a numerical display in place of a needle and is usually of the
high impedance type.
DIMMER SWITCH - Handor foot-operated switch that turns the high-beam filaments of headlights
on or off.
DIODE - Electrical device that permits current to flow in only one direction. Most often used as a
component in electronic controls and accessories. Also converts the output of an alternator from
AC to DC.
DIRECT CURRENT (DC) - Electric current flowing in one direction.
DISABLE - A type of microcomputer decision which results in an automotive system being
deactivated and not permitted to operate.
DISCHARGE - Term describing the flow of electric current from a battery. Opposite of charge.
DISPLAY - An output device used to display information. DISTRIBUTOR CAM - A shaft which is
geared to the camshaft on the bottom, and has lobes on the top which open and close the breaker
points. The rotor is also mounted on the top of this shaft just past the lobes.
DRIVER - A transistor in the output control area of the ECA that is used to turn on and off various
actuators.
DUTY CYCLE SIGNAL - A type of square-wave signal that does not have a constant on and off
time.
DURASPARK II - A breakerless, solid state ignition system introduced in 1978. DURASPARK II
used a module and coil similar to the earlier Solid State Ignition (SSI) system except for calibration.
This system incorporated an adapter on the distributor to accommodate the large distributor
terminal housing and larger rotor required for use with the higher voltage breakerless system. In
addition, spark plug wire diameter was increased to 8 mm and improved silicone jacketing was
incorporated.
E
EARTH - Term referring to a ground.
ECA - Electronic Control Assembly
E-CELL - A cell which deplates material from the anode to the cathode as a current in the
microampere range is passed through it. When the anode is completely deplated, the E-cell
becomes open which turns on a three stage transistor to switch a signal output.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 531
ELECTRODE - Posts or plates which have an electrical potential with respect to each other, such
as in a spark plug or battery. Electrodes are either positive or negative.
ELECTROLYTE - Active chemical filler in a battery.
ELECTROMAGNETIC - Refers to a device which incorporates both electronic and magnetic
principles together in its operation.
ELECTROMECHANICAL - Refers to a device which incorporates both electronic and mechanical
principles together in its operation. ELECTROMECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER Instrument cluster, first introduced on Taurus/Sable models, that utilizes magnetic gauges and an
"overlapping subassemblies" design. Use of the "overlapping sub-assemblies" design eases
service because individual gauge sub-assemblies can be removed as individual pieces.
ELECTRON - Negatively charged portion of an atom that orbits around the nucleus of the atom.
ELECTRONIC - An operation, produced or caused by the action of electrons or by devices which
function as a result of electron action. Electronic is often used to describe the control of systems or
devices by the use of small electrical signals and various semiconductor devices and circuits.
EMF - Electromotive force or voltage.
EMITTER - One of three elements or terminals of a transistor that emits the electrons that the
collector collects.
ENABLE - A type of microcomputer decision which results in an automotive system being activated
and permitted to operate.
ENERGIZED - Having the electrical current or electrical source turned on.
F
FAILURE MODE EFFECTS MANAGEMENT (FMEM) STRATEGY - EEC IV strategy designed to
reduce the adverse effects that may be caused by an EEC system sensor failure. Should a sensor
fail, the ECA substitutes a good sensor signal in its place. This allows the engine to keep running
so that the vehicle can be driven to the dealer for service.
FIELD (A/C) - A coil with many turns of wire located behind the clutch rotor. Current passing
through this coil sets up a magnetic field and causes the clutch to engage. FIELD - Magnetic lines
of force orientated from north to south as in a magnetic field. A magnetic field may be natural as
with a permanent magnet or created when electricity flows in a wire.
FIELD COIL - A coil of insulated wire usually wound around an iron core. Current flowing in the coil
produces a magnetic field. Also called "field winding." FILAMENT - A resistance in a light bulb
which glows and produces light when a current is forced through it.
FIRING LINE
FIRING LINE - The total amount of voltage being expended through the secondary circuit. FLUX Electric or magnetic lines of force passing or flowing in a magnetic field. Also, material used to
cause joining metal to adhere to both parts to be joined.
FOUR-WAY FLASHERS - See "hazard warning system."
FREE ELECTRON - Electrons that are not bound to a certain atom but are free to move around
from atom to atom.
FREQUENCY - Refers to the number of times something repeats itself (such as a signal from a
sensor) in one second.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 532
FUEL PUMP MONITOR (FPM) - Input used to monitor the fuel pump secondary circuit.
FUEL PUMP RELAY (FP) - Relay or its control line. Relay is controlled by ECA processor.
Supplies power to electric fuel pump of EFI/CFI system. FUSE - A metal link in a circuit that melts
when the current flow is excessive, thereby breaking the circuit.
FUSE BLOCK - An assembly concentrating most or all of a car's fuses at one point.
FUSIBLE LINK - A wire or bar designed to melt if more than a certain amount of electrical current is
transmitted through it. Often used as a main fuse or backup fuse for large sectional portions of a
car's electrical system.
G
GAIN - A comparison of an input signal level to an output signal level.
GASSING - The venting of hydrogen bubbles from battery acid as the battery is recharged.
GENERATOR - An electromechanical device that converts mechanical power into direct current
electricity.
GLOW PLUG IN CYLINDER HEAD
GLOW PLUG - An assembly that resembles spark plug but with a heating element instead of
electrodes. Used at the beginning of the starting cycle in a diesel engine to aid compression
ignition. Sometimes spelled "glo plug" GND (or Ground) - Common line for all vehicle power,
vehicle chassis ground and engine block ground, connected to vehicle battery negative terminal.
GROUND - The negatively charged side of a circuit. A ground can be a wire, the negative side of
the battery or even the vehicle chassis. The ground circuit must be at least the same size or bigger
than the positive (hot) wire.
GROUND CIRCUIT - The return side of an electric circuit. Usually the frame, body or engine of a
single-wire automotive system.
GROUNDING - Connecting one side of a car's electric circuit to the chassis, body, or engine.
These parts then provide a metal path that conducts electrical current back to the car's battery to
complete a circuit. Grounding may be done with a jumper wire.
GROUP - A set of battery plates, either positive or negative, joined together but not assembled with
separators.
GROWLER - An electrical device for testing electric motor or generator armatures for shorts.
H
HALF-WAVE - A pulsating DC produced by rectifying AC.
HALL-EFFECT - The "Hall Effect" is a process where current is passed through a small slice of
semi-conductor material at the same time as a magnetic field to produce a small voltage in the
semi-conductor.
HARD SOLDER - Uniting two pieces of metal with material having a melting point higher than "soft"
solder. Example: silver soldering. HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM - Electrical switching device and
associated lights (usually the front and rear turn-signal lights) producing flashes of light to indicate
that a car is in a distress situation. Also called "emergency flashers" or "fourway flashers".
HEAT RANGE - A classification for spark plugs. The higher the number, the "hotter" the plug runs,
which means that the plug does not dissipate heat as quickly as a "cooler" plug does.
HEAT SINK - Metal bracket in end frame of alternator that contains and absorbs heat from diodes.
HIGH TENSION - Secondary or induced high voltage electrical current. Circuit includes wiring fron.
ignition distributor cap to coil and to each spark
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 533
plug.
HIGH TENSION SECONDARY VOLTAGE - Voltage which enables current to jump the spark plug
gap. This voltage is caused by the collapse of the magnetic field around the coil secondary
windings.
HOLE - A moveable vacancy which acts as a positive charge in a semi-conductor.
HORN RELAY - Electromagnetic circuit-closing device that switches electricity to the horn when
the horn button is depressed.
HOT LEAD - A wire, or conductor, in the hot or power circuit.
HYDROMETER - An instrument used to measure the specific gravity of liquids. Hydrometers can
be calibrated to indicate the charge level of a battery or the percentage of antifreeze in a coolant
mixture.
I
IDENTIFICATION CODE - A single digit, selftest service code, output at the beginning of the
"engine running" test which is equal to one-half of the number of engine cylinders.
IGNITION RESERVE - The differential between available voltage and the required voltage.
IGNITION SWITCH - Key-operated main power switch in a car. Its chief function is to close the
primary ignition circuit, but modern designs include several other circuits and even a steering
column lock.
IGNITION SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM - All the components that together produce the ignition spark: battery,
distributor, ignition coil, spark plugs and associated switches and wiring. IMAGE LINE - The
electronic picture tracing as seen on the screen of an oscilloscope.
IMPEDANCE - A form of opposition to AC current flow (resistance) measured in OHMS.
INDUCTION - The spontaneous creation of an electric current in a coil as it passes through a
magnetic field.
INERTIA SWITCH - A switch in the fuel pump circuit which shuts off power to the fuel pump in the
event the vehicle is involved in a collision. This switch must be manually reset.
INPUT - Information provided to a microcomputer to allow accurate control of a system.
INPUT CONDITIONER - A device or circuit that conditions or prepares an input signal for use by a
microcomputer. INSULATION - Materials which do not readily conduct electricity.
INSULATOR - A nonconducting substance or body, such as porcelain, glass, or bakelite used for
insulating wires in electrical circuits to prevent the leakage of electricity.
INTEGRAL RELAY CONTROL MODULE (IRCM) - A module which interfaces with the EEC-IV
processor to provide control of the cooling fan, A/C clutch and fuel pump. The module also
incorporates the EEC power relay to provide power to the EEC-IV system.
INTEGRATED CIRCUIT (IC) - A small semiconductor device that contains thousands of
component parts and is capable of doing many circuit functions. Also called "chips"
INTEGRATED VEHICLE SPEED CONTROL (IVSC) - A Ford speed control system which is
integrated with the on-board EEC TV engine control system. This system does not require an
amplifier because all computer control is through the EEC IV processor.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 534
INVERTERA - A circuit that takes an input and converts it to the opposite state in the output.
J
JUICE - A slang term for electricity.
K
KILOWATT - A measurement of power equal to 1,000 watts. 100 volts flowing at the rate of 10
amperes equals 1 kilowatt. Abbreviation is kw or KW.
KILOWATT HOUR - The work accomplished by an agent operating at a power level of a kilowatt
for one hour. 1kw. hr. = 1,000 watts x 3,600 seconds or 3,600,000 watt seconds. kw or KW Abbreviation for kilowatt.
L
LEAD - (1) An elemental metal that is heavy, pliable and easily melted. (2) Abbreviated term for
tetraethyl lead. (3) A wire conductor.
LEAD SULFATE - A product of the electrochemical action in a lead-acid battery. The sulfate
deposit forms on the plates and slowly fouls the battery.
LIGHT-EMITTING DIODE (LED) - A positivenegative junction of crystal material, housed in a
dome-shaped housing, which produces light when forward bias current is applied.
LINEAR POTENTIOMETER - A variable resistance whose resistance changes in direct proportion
to the travel of the moveable terminal.
LOAD - An electrical device connected into a circuit to provide a resistance and control the rate of
current rate.
LOAD TEST - (1) A test for starter motors in which the current draw is measured while the engine
is cranking. (2) A battery test.
LOGIC GATE - A circuit that will give an output when certain inputs are present.
LOW FREQUENCY OSCILLATIONS - The long-tracing vertical image lines which are seen in the
coil section.
M
MAGNET - Any body with the property of attracting iron or steel.
MAGNETIC FIELD - The area surrounding the poles of a magnet which is affected by its attraction
or repulsion forces.
MAGNETIC GAUGE - Special type of instrument gauge, used in the electro-mechanical instrument
cluster, that accurately show values even when the ignition is off.
MAGNETIC PICKUP COIL - Coil used in the distributor of the breakerless solid state ignition
systems to determine exactly when to switch off the coil secondary. MAGNETIC RELUCTANCE The resistance of a magnetic path to the flow of magnetic flux lines through it.
MAGNETIC SWITCH - A switch operated by a small electromagnet. Solenoids and relays are
magnetic switches.
MAGNETO - A type of generator used in early vehicles which produced an extremely high voltage
spark.
MICROCOMPUTER - A device that takes information, processes it, makes decisions and outputs
those decisions. Microcomputers are generally small and portable, and are located inside a
processor.
MICROPROCESSOR - A small processor contained within the on-board computer (processor).
MINIMUM SPEED LOCKOUT (MSLO) - An additional safety feature added to Ford speed control
systems that prevents speed control operation at very low speeds.
MODULE - A control assembly. A module could be any package that is intended to perform a
specific task (such as ignition). Usually modules can be disconnected and replaced easily.
MOTOR - Electromechanical device that converts electricity into mechanical energy.
MULTIPLE FUNCTION WARNING INDICATOR - A warning indicator assembly, first introduced on
the 1987 Mustang GT that indicates low oil, low coolant, low fuel, and low washer conditions.
N
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 535
N-TYPE - A semi-conductor material that has an excess of free electrons.
NAND GATE - A type of logic device that requires all inputs to be YES in order for the output to be
NO.
NEGATIVE POLE - Point from which an electrical current flows as it passes through a circuit.
NO-LOAD TEST - A test for starter motors in which current draw is measured when the starter's
pinion gear is not engaged.
NOR GATE - A type of logic circuit that if either input is YES, the output is NO.
NORMALLY CLOSED - Refers to a switch or a solenoid that is closed when no control or force is
acting on it.
NORMALLY OPEN - Refers to a switch or solenoid that is open when no control or force is acting
on it.
NOT GATE - A type of logic circuit that has an inverted output; if the input is YES, the output is NO,
and vice versa.
NPN - A transistor with a P type base sandwiched between an N type emitter and collector.
O
OHM - A unit of electrical resistance opposing current flow. Resistance varies in different materials
and varies with temperature.
OHMMETER
OHMMETER - An instrument that measures electrical resistance of a conductor in units called
ohms. OHM'S LAW - A law of electricity which states the relationship between voltage, current and
resistance. It takes an electromotive force of one volt to force one ampere of current through one
ohm of resistance. Equation - volts = amperes x ohms (E = I x R)
ON DEMAND TEST - In Self-Test, the Key On/Engine Off and Engine Running positions, which are
technician initiated, are run from a program within the processor.
OPEN CIRCUIT - An electrical circuit that because of break or because a switch has failed to close
is not complete. See also "short circuit."
OPEN LOOP - A system that does not feed back its output to its input.
OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER - A device with two inputs and one output having a very high voltage
gain.
OPTIC SENSOR - A device that produces a voltage signal by using a light source, a light sensitive
material and a slotted wheel between the two.
OR GATE - A type of logic circuit that if either input is YES, the output is YES.
OSCILLATION - A rapid back-and-forth movement.
OSCILLOSCOPE - Instrument that converts voltage and frequency readings into traces on a
cathrode ray tube.
OUTPUT - Decisions or commands issued by a microcomputer to output devices to allow displays
and actuators to function.
OUTPUT CONTROL - Circuits inside of the ECA that are used to turn external devices on and off.
OUTPUT CYCLING CHECK (OCC) - A position of the end of the Key On/Engine Off test that
enables energizing and de-energizing the auxiliary output on demand.
OUTPUT DRIVER - A transistor in the output control area of the processor that is used to turn
various actuators on and off.
OUTPUT STATE CHECK - A test performed in the Key On/Engine Off mode after the continuous
codes have been sent which forces the processor to
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 536
activate some actuators for additional diagnostics.
OVERCHARGING - Continuing to charge a battery after it has a full charge; can damage the
battery.
P
P TYPE - A semi-conductor material that has holes or a lack of electrons.
PARALLEL CIRCUIT
PARALLEL - Electrical design in which two or more circuits, batteries or components share
common negative and positive connections. PASSIVE CIRCUIT - A circuit consisting of all passive
elements, resistors, capacitors or inductors. PASSIVE SENSOR - A sensor which modifies the
output of a voltage-divider network that the sensor is part of.
PERMEABLE - A characteristic of how good a material is as a magnetic path.
PHOTOELECTRIC CELL (PE) - A light sensitive material that changes variations of light into
varying voltage signals.
PHOTOTRANSISTOR - A light sensitive transistor that generates an output signal in proportion to
the light picked up.
PICKUP COIL
PICKUP COIL - An electromagnetic device in the distributor of the electronic ignition system. It
creates an electromagnetic field due to the permanent magnet that is part of the pickup assembly.
Then the magnetic field produces an a.c. signal to the control module, informing the module of the
turning position of the distributor shaft. PIEZOELECTRIC - Refers to an electronic device which is
capable of generating a voltage when subjected to mechanical pressure.
PLATE - (1) Component of a storage battery, one of a series of flat lead sheets with which acid
reacts to produce electricity. (2) A pivoting flap in the choke or throttle valve of a carburetor. (3) To
apply a coating or layer of one material over another.
PNP - A transistor with an N type base sandwiched between a P type emitter and collector. POINT
GAP - The space between the point contacts which is adjusted to provide the correct dwell.
POLARITY - The difference in properties or powers between two bodies or the ends of one body,
as in a magnet. According to the Current Theory, polarities in an electric circuit are established by
an excess of electrons on one side (negative) and a deficiency on the other (positive).
POSITIVE TEMPERATURE COEFFICIENT (PTC) HEATER - A heater system used on chokes
and on diesel fuel heaters. PTC heaters are self regulating because as their temperature rises so
too does the resistance limiting the amount of electrical flow and overall heating.
POSITIVE TERMINAL - That terminal in a circuit to which current flows.
POTENTIAL - Electrical force measured in volts. Sometimes used interchangeably with voltage.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 537
POTENTIAL DIFFERENCE - A difference of electrical pressure that sets up a flow of electric
current.
POTENTIAL DROP - A loss of electrical pressure due to resistance.
POTENTIOMETER
POTENTIOMETER (POT) - A variable resistor with three connections. The third connection (wiper)
moves physically up and down the resistive element which has each end attached to one of the
other two connections. PRIMARY - (1) A low-voltage circuit or part of a circuit. (2) The input coil of
a transformer. PRIMARY WINDING - Low voltage winding of the coil which is electronically
connected to its secondary only by the magnetic field they share. When the primary winding is
connected across, a potential current flows through it, building a magnetic field around itself and
inducing a voltage in the secondary. When disconnected, the cease in current through the primary
again induces a voltage in the secondary which is used to ignite the air/fuel mixture.
PRINTED CIRCUIT - Electrically conductive metal paths that are produced by printing a pattern on
a board, then etching away all areas that are not printed.
PROCESSOR - A metal housing which contains a microcomputer and other components used in
providing electronic system control. The Electronic Control Assembly (ECA) is often referred to as
the processor.
PROGRAM - A set of detailed instructions which a microcomputer follows when controlling a
system.
PULSE - An abrupt change in voltage whether positive or negative.
PULSE WIDTH - The length of time an actuator, such as a fuel injector, remains energized.
Q
QUARTZ-HALOGEN HEADLIGHT - A modern headlight design that produces a much brighter,
whiter light than the conventional tungsten-filament light. The bulb is made of, quartz, rather than
glass, and is filled with a halogen gas. Also called "halogen headlight."
R
RANDOM ACCESS MEMORY (RAM) - A type of memory which is used to store information
temporarily. Information can be written to and read from RAM.
READ - A microcomputer operation where information is retrieved from memory.
READ ONLY MEMORY (ROM) - A type of memory which is used to store information permanently.
Information can not be written to ROM; as the name implies, information can only be read from
ROM.
READOUT CONTROL - Circuits inside of the ECA that are used for operating digital instrument
displays.
RECHARGE - (1) To restore energy to a battery by means of an electric current. (2) To restore the
level of a substance in a system, as recharging an air conditioner with refrigerant.
RECTIFIER (diode) - Electrical device that permits alternating current to flow in only one direction
thereby transforming it into direct current.
REDUNDANT BRAKE SHUTOFF - A safety feature of Ford speed control systems that shuts the
speed control system off if there is a 10-15 mph drop in speed.
REFERENCE VOLTAGE (VREF) - Power supplied by the ECA to some sensors that are regulated
at a specific voltage.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 538
STARTER RELAY
RELAY - An electromagnetic switching device using low current to open or close a high-current
circuit. RELUCTANCE - The resistance of a material to the flow of magnetic lines of force.
REQUIRED VOLTAGE - Voltage necessary to overcome the resistance of the secondary circuit
and establish a spark to the ground electrode of the spark plug.
RESERVE CAPACITY - The length of time that a fully charged battery at 80~F will remain
functional when it is discharging at a rate of 25 amps. This rating is intended to tell the driver how
long the car can be operated with headlights and certain other accessories on after an alternator
failure.
RESIDUAL MAGNETISM - Slight magnetic properties retained by metal, such as a wiring coil in a
generator, after it has passed through a magnetic field.
RESISTANCE - The opposition offered by a conductor to a flow of electricity; measured in ohms.
RESISTOR - A device installed in an electrical circuit which tends to prevent or reduce the flow of
current.
RESUME - An operating mode of the speed control system which reactivates the system after it
has been disabled (such as by stepping on the brake or clutch pedal) and returns it to the speed at
which it was previously set. Shutting the vehicle off erases the resume memory.
RHEOSTAT - A device for regulating a current by means of a variable resistance.
ROTOR
ROTOR - The rotating part of a distributor that transfers current from the coil cable to the spark
plug cables.
S
SAMPLING - The act of periodically collecting or sending information. A microcomputer samples
input from various sensors in the process of controlling a system. SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM Symbolic representation of an electric circuit or vacuumhose circuit.
SEALED-BEAM - Headlight design incorporating filaments, reflector, and a lens in a unit with no
separate bulb.
SECONDARY - (1) A high-voltage circuit or part of a circuit. (2) The output coil of a transformer.
SECONDARY CIRCUIT - The high voltage part of the ignition system which extends from the
center tower of the coil all the way down to and across the spark plug gap.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 539
SECONDARY INSULATION (SPARK PLUG WIRE)
SECONDARY INSULATION - The material that contains the spark from the time it leaves the
center tower of the coil to the time it reaches the insulated electrode of the spark plug.
SECONDARY RESISTANCE - The resistance encountered by electricity as it travels on its route
from the center tower of the coil to the ground electrode of the spark plug.
SECONDARY WINDING - See "Secondary Circuit."
SEMICONDUCTOR - General term for transistors, integrated circuits, and other electronic devices
made of materials, such as silicone, that conduct electricity poorly.
SENSOR - Used as inputs to the ECA, a device that measures a condition and converts it into
some kind of electrical signal. SERIES - An electrical connection in which two or more circuits,
batteries or components are connected negative to positive. The opposite of "parallel."
SERVO - In a speed control system, a vacuum operated device controlled by the amplifier
responsible for changing the throttle plate settings in relationship to engine speed. The servo
contains solenoid valves for controlling vacuum to the diaphragm and a throttle position sensor
(servo in IVSC system does not contain throttle position sensor).
SET/ACCEL - In a speed control system, a driver control button that is responsible for setting a
speed. It can also be used to raise the speed by holding it down until the desired speed is reached.
SHIFT INDICATOR LIGHT (SIL) - A system primarily controlled by engine speed and manifold
vacuum which provides a visual indication to the driver of when to shift to the next higher gear to
obtain fuel economy.
SHORT CIRCUIT - Defect in an electric circuit in which electricity flows directly from one conductor
to another rather than through the intended circuit.
SHUNT - A conductor joining two points in a circuit so as to form a parallel circuit through which a
portion of the current may pass in order to regulate the amount of current flowing in the main
circuit.
SHUNT CIRCUIT - A minor side circuit that parallels and feeds off a main circuit.
SIGNAL - A voltage condition that transmits specific information in an electronic system.
SIGNAL PROCESSING - A general term used for conditioning input signals. It covers many
functions such as A/D converting, amplifying, counting, etc. It describes what happens to input
signals from the sensor on their way to the microprocessor.
SINE-WAVE - A voltage signal generated by a coil of wire, a magnetic field and movement
between them. SLIP RING - A circular conductor on a rotor or armature that contacts brushes.
Electricity flows from the brushes to the slip ring, thus allowing current to pass from a stationary
part to a rotating part.
SLOW CHARGE - The preferred method of administering a charge to a battery where current is
applied over a long period of time and at a low rate.
SOLENOID - A wire coil with a moveable core which changes position by means of
electromagnetism when current flows through the coil. Sometimes synonymous with "relay."
SOLENOID RELAY - A switching component in the starter motor circuit. Light current operates the
solenoid, which closes the contacts carrying the heavy current to the starter motor.
SOLENOID SWITCH - A switch operated by a solenoid.
SOLENOID VACUUM SWITCH - Any one of a variety of engine control devices that combine a
solenoid switch and a vacuum valve. The solenoid opens or closes a valve in a vacuum line,
usually as part of a pollution-control system.
SOLID STATE - General term for transistors and related electronic components that are replacing
vacuum tubes.
SOLID STATE IGNITION (SSI) - The ignition systems that used a transistor to switch the coil. One
used breaker points to switch on the transistor, the
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 540
other used the magnetic pickup coil. Both of these systems precede the Duraspark systems, but
the one that used the pickup coil is the same.
SPARK ADVANCE - Causing the ignition spark to occur earlier.
SPARK GAP - The space between the spark plugs center electrode and ground electrode. SPARK
LINE - The pattern that represents the time during which the air/fuel mixture is being burned within
the combustion chamber.
SPARK PLUG - Electrical component that produces a spark to ignite the air/fuel mixture in the
cylinders.
SPARK RETARD - Causing less spark advance to be added, resulting in an ignition spark
introduced later.
SPLICE - The joining of two or more conductors at a single point by crimping, soldering or brazing.
SQUARE-WAVE - A digital on-off type of signal that has a very fast rise and fall.
STARTER - The electric motor and drive mechanism used to start an engine.
STOPLAMP SWITCH - Switch responsible for disabling the speed control system when the brakes
are applied. Also responsible for operating the stoplamps when the brake pedal is depressed.
STORAGE CELLS - A cell which stores potential for electricity in the form of chemicals. Once
discharged it can be recharged by forcing current through it in the opposite direction. These cells,
when placed in series, form a storage battery.
STRATEGY - The programming of the ECA determining how it reacts under certain conditions.
Some currently used strategies are Failure Mode Effects Management (FMEM), Idle, Lean Cruise,
etc.
SWITCH - A device used to open, close or redirect the current in an electrical circuit.
T
TERMINAL - A device attached to the end of a wire or cable to make an electrical connection.
THERMISTOR - A resistor that changes its resistance with temperature.
THERMOCOUPLE - A thermoelectric device used to measure temperature accurately, especially
one consisting of two dissimilar metals joined together so that a potential difference is generated
between the points of contact. The amount of potential difference is a measure of the heat at the
point of contact of the two dissimilar metals.
THICK FILM IGNITION (TFI) -IV - Electronic ignition system utilizing a Hall-Effect sensor to switch
the ignition coil on and off through the ECA. The term "thick film" is Lised to describe the process
used to build the TFI circuit on the module. The basic circuit is placed on a layer of alumina.
Several layers of film are required to print the circuit - hence the name "thick film." The resistors
and connecting paths are part of the film. Other components such as capacitors, diodes, darlington
transistors and integrated circuits are added on top of the thick film or are attached to it. There are
two TFI systems, TFI-I used on 1982 1.6L engines, and TFI-II used on engines after 1983 with
EEC-IV. The TFI-IV ignition system uses no vacuum or centrifugal advance, all advance is
controlled by the ECA. TFII utilizes vacuum and centrifugal advance. Both TFI-I and IV use an
E-core coil instead of an oil filled coil.
THICK FILM IGNITION (TFI) MODULE - Smaller module which is mounted on the distributor and
fires the ignition coil.
THROUGHPUT - The flow of a voltage signal from input to output.
TIMER - A feature of microcomputers which allows the microcomputer to measure time intervals,
such as "time since engine start" or "time in neutral idle." TRANSDUCER - A device that changes
energy from one form to another. For example, a transducer is used to change the pulse of fuel
injection in a diesel to electricity so that timing can be checked. In automotive air-conditioning
controls used in automatic temperature systems, a transducer changes an electrical signal to a
vacuum signal, which operates mechanical doors.
TRANSFER HOSE - Hose on the speed control servo that connects either manifold vacuum or
atmospheric pressure to the sealed side of the diaphragm, depending on servo solenoid positions.
TRANSISTOR - A small solid-state electronic switching device which uses semiconductors. Widely
used to replace vacuum tubes and switches.
TRUTH TABLE - A chart that lists all of the possible combinations of inputs and the corresponding
outputs for a logic gate.
U
UNIVERSAL DISTRIBUTOR - Distributor which uses a PIP sensor instead of a CP sensor, and TFI
module instead of the Dura-Spark ignition module. This distributor can be used with EEC only.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 541
V
VACUUM DUMP VALVE - A valve that mechanically releases the vacuum from the servo when the
brake pedal is depressed.
VACUUM SOLENOID VALVE - An electrically operated vacuum on and off valve similar in
operation to a relay.
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR - Device mounted on the transmission or speedometer cable that is
responsible for monitoring vehicle speed and passing the information on to the speed control
amplifier or EEC IV module.
VOLT - The unit of measurement for the force or pressure of a flow of electricity.
VOLTAGE - The electrical pressure which causes current to flow in a circuit. VOLTAGE APPLIED The actual voltage read at a given point in a circuit. It equals the available voltage of the power
supply minus the losses in the circuit up to that point.
VOLTAGE AVAILABLE - The voltage delivered by the power supply (battery, alternator, generator,
etc.).
VOLTAGE DIVIDER - Two or more resistances connected in series form a voltage divider network.
When current flows the voltage divides itself across the resistances.
VOLTAGE DROP - A lowering of the voltage in a circuit when resistance, or electrical load, is
added.
VOLTAGE REGULATOR - An electrical device that prevents excessive voltage on, or overcharge
of, the battery by the generator or alternator.
VOLTMETER - An instrument used to measure the voltage in an electrical circuit.
VOLT-OHM-METER (VOM) - Combination meter used to measure voltage and resistance (ohms).
They are available in both analog (measures by needle movement) or digital (measures by a
numeric display). May be referred to as an AVOM (analog) or DVOM (digital).
VREF - Abbreviation for reference voltage.
W
WATT - A measurement of power. One volt multiplied by 1 amp equals 1 watt, and 746 watts equal
1 horsepower. One "kilowatt" equals 1,000 watts. WIGGLE TEST - Performed with either a
voltmeter or star tester while wiggling or tapping the system harness connectors.
WIPER - Refer to "potentiometer."
WIRING HARNESS - A bundle of insulated electrical wires covered by an additional insulating
jacket. The individual wires emerge from the harness at different points to go to various
components.
WRITE - A microcomputer operation where information is sent to and stored in memory.
X
X-NOR GATE - A logic circuit that requires both inputs to be the same for a YES output.
X-OR GATE - A logic circuit that requires both inputs to be the same for a NO output.
Z
ZENER DIODE - A two terminal device with 1 PN junction that can conduct in the reverse direction
when a certain voltage is reached.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 542
Power and Ground Distribution: Technical Service Bulletins Wire Harness Terminal and Connector
- Service Kit
WIRING-WIRE HARNESS TERMINAL AND CONNECTOR SERVICE KIT Article No. 89-19-5
FORD:
1990 and prior ALL FORD LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1990 and prior ALL LINCOLN-MERCURY LINES
MERKUR: 1990 and prior ALL MERKUR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1990 and prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1990 and prior ALL MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK LINES This TSB article is
being republished in its entirety to make dealers aware of availability of the wiring harness terminal
and connector repair kit.
ISSUE: A wire harness terminal and connector repair kit is available for repairing electrical wire
harnesses. This kit allows dealers to repair broken or corroded terminals and connectors instead of
replacing an entire wire harness. The kit is easy to use and allows the technician to perform a
professional looking repair in a short period of time.
ACTION: To purchase a wire harness terminal and connector repair kit, contact Altair International
Incorporated. Refer to the following information for ordering details.
ALTAIR INTERNATIONAL INC.
ATTN: SALES DEPARTMENT
22800 HALL ROAD
MT. CLEMENS, MI 48043
TELEPHONE: (313) 466-1200
An order form is included in the back of this TSB issue. To order:
^ Fill out the order form.
^ Enclose a check for the total amount. (This kit cannot be charged to your dealership parts code.)
^ Send the completed form and check to the ALTAIR INTERNATIONAL INC.
The kit consists of:
^ Two 50 drawer metal cabinets that contain 6 each of the 96 different terminals, machined
crimped with a four inch "pigtail" of 12 or 16 gauge wire.
^ A unique, high compression crimping tool that will make sure of a solid connection preventing
moisture or contaminants from affecting the wire splice.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: none SUPERSEDES:
88-17-5, Date 8/17/88
WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS CODES:
2770, 2700
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 543
Technical Service Bulletin # 87153 Date: 870729
Wiring - Circuit Number/Color Code Charts
WIRING - CORPORATE STANDARD CIRCUIT Article No.
NUMBER CHARTS FOR WIRE CIRCUIT NUMBER, 87-15-3
AND COLOR CODES
FORD: 1980-88 ALL CAR LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-88 ALL CAR LINES
MERKUR: 1985-88 XR4Ti 1988 SCORPIO
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-88 F SERIES, BRONCO 1983-88 RANGER 1984-88 BRONCO II 1986-88
AEROSTAR
ISSUE: The Standard Circuit Number Charts on pages 11 through 20 of this TSB are being printed
for your information. The electrical circuits are listed by number code with the description/name and
the matching color code as specified by Ford Corporate Standards. These charts are also printed
in the reference section of the Vacuum and Wiring Manual.
ACTION: When tracing circuits or trying to pinpoint individual circuits, use these charts with the
appropriate Shop Manual, EVTM (Electrical and Vacuum Troubleshooting Manual), or the Vacuum
and Wiring Manual.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Wiring Color Codes
The wire color code indicates the circuit number, color of the wire and the wire gauge size.
Where two colors are shown for a wire, the first color is the basic color of the wire. The second
color is the dot, hash, or stripe marking. If D or H is given, the second color is dots or hash marks.
If there is no letter after the second color, the wire has a stripe.
For example:
BR/O is a brown wire with an orange stripe.
R/Y D is a red wire with yellow dots.
BK/W H is a black wire with white hash marks.
Color Abbreviations
BL Blue N Natural
BK Black O Orange
BR Brown PK Pink
DB Dark Blue P Purple
DG Dark Green R Red
GR Green T Tan
GY Gray W White
LB Light Blue Y Yellow
LG Light Green
If a vehicle specific wire color in a connector does not match the diagram shown, it can usually be
identified by comparing the other colors shown at the wire connectors. Specific wire color
deviations in the manufacturing of a wire harness are usually for a short duration.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 544
WIRE TYPES
Standard Circuit Number Chart
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 545
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 546
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 547
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 548
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 549
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 550
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 551
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 552
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 553
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Electrical/Electronic/Fuel Induction - Glossary > Page 554
STANDARD CIRCUIT NUMBER CHART
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications
Alignment: Specifications
Caster
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... +3/4° - 1 1/4°
Camber
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... +1/2° - 1 1/4°
Toe-inches
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 0" - 1/4"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Adhesives & Sealants - Availability and Usage
Steering: Technical Service Bulletins Adhesives & Sealants - Availability and Usage
^ ADHESIVES AND SEALANTS-AVAILABILITY AND USAGE
^ ENGINE-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTS-AVILABILITY AND USAGE
^ STEERING-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTSAVAILABILITY AND USAGE
^ TRANSMISSION-ADHESIVES AND SEALANTSAVAILABILITY AND USAGE
Article No. 89-12-2
FORD: 1989 and prior ALL FORD LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1989 and prior ALL LINCOLN-MERCURY LINES
MERKUR: 1989 and prior ALL MERKUR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1989 and prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1989 and prior ALL MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: Various adhesives and sealants are used to perform many service repairs. A partial list of
these Ford products that are available through the Ford Parts System along with their proper use
and application is shown below.
ACTION: If adhesives and sealants are required to perform a service repair, refer to the following
product information and the appropriate Shop Manual.
Ford Stud And Bearing Mount (EOAZ-19554-BA)/ Ford Threadlocker 262 (E2FZ-19554-B)
These adhesives are high strength threadlockers. They are used for locking all fasteners that must
withstand:
^ Heavy shock and vibration.
^ Extreme chemical and environmental conditions, such as solvents, oils, and water immersion.
They prevent fluid/vacuum leaks and seal out rust or corrosion. Their typical applications include
securing the following items.
^ Intake manifold bolts
^ Power steering pump adjusting bolts
^ Engine studs
^ Ring gear bolts
^ Seat bolts
^ Cup plugs
To use these adhesives, clean the fastener threads with a wire brush and a non-petroleum based
solvent. Apply one or two drops to the threads and torque to the required specifications.
NOTE: THESE ARE HIGH STRENGTH THREADLOCKERS AND THEY REQUIRE SPECIAL
EFFORT FOR REMOVAL.
Ford Threadlock And Sealer (EOAZ-19554-AA)
This product is a medium strength threadlocker and sealer which stops air, oil, and fuel leakage. It
is a hand tool removable adhesive and is used on aluminum threads. It prevents fluid/vacuum leaks
and seals out rust or corrosion. Its typical applications include sealing and securing the following
items.
^ Oil pan bolts
^ Valve cover bolts
^ Flywheel attaching bolts
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Adhesives & Sealants - Availability and Usage > Page 563
^ Door latch attaching bolts
To use this adhesive, clean the fastener threads with a wire brush and a non-petroleum based
solvent. Apply one or two drops to the threads and torque to the required specifications. Ford Pipe
Sealant With Teflon (D8AZ-19554-A)
This product seals and locks air, oil, fuel and hydraulic threaded fasteners. This light paste sealant
instantly seals without fouling. It is non-shredding and operates in temperatures up to 400~F. It
prevents corrosion of fitting /fastener threads and locks against vibrational loosening. Its typical
applications include sealing the following items.
^ Transmission oil coolant lines
^ Fuel inlet fittings
^ Intake manifold vacuum switches
^ Engine oil galley plugs
To use this sealer, clean off residual oil, coolant and other contaminants from the threads. Apply
sealer completely around the second and third threads. Install the part and torque to the required
specifications.
Ford Gasket Maker (E2AZ-19562-B) And Ford Gasket Eliminator (E1FZ-19562-A)
These products cure in the absence of air. They are used to gasket two machined surfaced
flanges. Each product will fill a gap up to .010". The sealants will not cure until the parts are
assembled. Once cured, they will remain pliable and flex with movement of the parts. Their typical
applications include sealing the following items.
^ Oil dip stick tubes
^ MTX case halves (Gasket Eliminator)
^ Water Pumps
^ Input bearing retainers
^ Rear main bearing parting lines
To use these sealants, make sure all the old gasket material has been removed. CAUTION: AVOID
USING METAL SCRAPERS BECAUSE THEY CAN ETCH THE SURFACES AND PREVENT A
GOOD SEAL.
Clean both surfaces with a non-petroleum based solvent to remove all oil, grease and other
contaminants. Apply a small bead of sealant continuously around one surface only and then put the
pieces together.
NOTE: REMEMBER, THESE PRODUCTS CURE IN THE ABSENCE OF AIR, SO PLENTY OF
TIME IS AVAILABLE TO DO A THOROUGH JOB.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E0AZ-19554-BA Stud and Bearings Mount BM
E2FZ-19554-B Ford Threadlocker 262 R
E0AZ-19554-AA Threadlock and Sealer B
D8AZ-19554-A Pipe Sealant with Teflon B
E2AZ-19562-B Gasket Maker AM
E1FZ-19562-A Gasket Eliminator AM
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Suspension - Vehicle Lean or Spring Sag
Suspension: Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Vehicle Lean or Spring Sag
Article No. ^ SPRINGS - RATE AND CAPACITY 87-19-10 INFORMATION
^ SUSPENSION - VEHICLE LEAN OR SPRING SAG
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-88 ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: Vehicle lean, or spring sag conditions, are more often related to payload/body weights
(especially on recreational vehicles) than to weakened or sagged springs. Sometimes, springs may
be replaced unnecessarily because the available spring information in the Light Truck Sales Data
Book is not used.
ACTION: If service is required, make sure of proper spring usage. The vehicle should first be
weighed (front, rear, and total) so that the values can be compared to the ratings on the vehicle's
certification label. Vehicle design heights for curb (empty) and loaded vehicles are included in the
Body Builder's Layout Book. Spring rates, capacities, and codes are listed in the Light Truck Sales
Data Book. The spring charts will provide full information for the spring's characteristics. (Both
books should be available in the dealership sales department.)
Comparing vehicle weights, rated capacities, and design height should determine the cause of
most sag/lean concerns. If more help is necessary, contact the Technical Service Hotline.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Warner Compressor Clutch Replacement
Compressor Clutch: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Warner Compressor Clutch Replacement
Article No. 85-4-3
AIR CONDITIONING - REPLACEMENT OF WARNER A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
FORD 1980-84 ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1980-84 ALL
LIGHT TRUCK 1980-84 ALL LIGHT TRUCKS
When existing stock of 1980-84 Warner Electric A/C compressor clutch hub and pulley parts is
exhausted, it will be necessary to replace the entire clutch assembly, including the field coil, with
current Ford manufactured clutch parts. Replacement of the Warner field coil is necessary because
it is not compatible with the Ford clutch parts. The Warner field coil will continue to be available for
replacement on Warner clutch assemblies.
NOTE: Never intermix clutch parts from different manufacturers. Refer to the Master Parts Catalog
for part numbers and vehicle application.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips
Article No. 85-8-2
HEATER CORE - LEAK - DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
Good heater cores are being returned through the parts return system coded as leaking.
Complaints of leaking may be caused by an inadequate seal between the heater hose and the
heater core tubes allowing coolant to follow the tube to the heater core, leak into the passenger
compartment and appear as a leaking heater core.
When diagnosing a suspect heater core leak, inspect the hose to heater core tube attachment to
assure the connection is not leaking. If a leaking connection is found, correct the leak. If the
connection appears not to be leaking, leak test the heater core before removing it from the vehicle
using the following procedure:
HEATER CORE LEAK TEST
Pressure Test 1.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater hoses from the heater core tubes.
3. Install a short piece of heater hose (approximately 4 inches long) on each heater core tube.
Figure 1
4. Fill the heater core and hoses with water and install plug BT-7422-B and adapter BT-7422-A
from Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent in the hose ends (Figure 1). Secure the hoses, plug
and adapter with hose clamps.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips > Page 578
Figure 2
Figure 3 - TOOL 021-00012 WITH HEATER HOSE AND CLAMPS
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent to the adapter
(Figure 2). Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge and pump 30 psi of air pressure into the
heater core (Figure 3).
6. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of three minutes. The pressure should not drop.
7. If the pressure does not drop, no leaks are indicated.
8. If the pressure drops, check the hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the hoses do not
leak, remove the heater core from the vehicle and perform the bench test.
Bench Test 1.
Drain all coolant from the heater core.
Figure 4 - HEATER CORE BENCH TEST
2. Connect the 4-inch test hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes. Then connect the air
pump and gauge assembly to the adapter (Figure 4).
3. Apply 30 psi of air pressure to the heater core with Rotunda model 021-00012 or equivalent, and
submerge the core in water.
4. If a leak is observed, service or replace the heater core as necessary.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Heater Core - Leakage Diagnostic Tips > Page 579
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Air Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye
Article No. 93-20-6
09/29/93
AIR CONDITIONING - USE OF CORRECT FLUORESCENT TRACER DYE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 1980-93 CROWN VICTORIA 1981-93 ESCORT 1982-83 FAIRMONT 1982-88 EXP
1982-93 MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1983-86 LTD 1984-93 TEMPO 1986-93 TAURUS 1988-93
FESTIVA 1989-93 PROBE
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-93 GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN CAR 1981-87 LYNX 1982-83 LN7,
ZEPHYR 1982-86 CAPRI 1982-93 CONTINENTAL, COUGAR 1983-86 MARQUIS 1984-92 MARK
VII 1984-93 TOPAZ 1986-93 SABLE 1991-93 CAPRI, TRACER
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-93 BRONCO, ECONOLINE, F-150-350 SERIES 1983-93 RANGER 1984-90
BRONCO II 1986-93 AEROSTAR 1988-93 F-47 1991-93 EXPLORER 1993 VILLAGER
ISSUE: Use of untested, unapproved fluorescent tracer dyes for A/C system leak checking may
damage the air conditioning system. Some of these materials may not be compatible with Ford A/C
systems.
ACTION: When leak-checking an R-12 A/C system with a "black light", use only Rotunda-supplied
Part No. 112-R0027, Fluoro-Lite brand dye. No other dyes have been approved by Ford Motor
Company.
NOTE: 112-R0027 DYE IS NOT COMPATIBLE WITH R-134a REFRIGERANT.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS
CODES: 208999
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye > Page 584
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins R-12 Refrigerant - Substitutes
Article No. 94-14-3
07/13/94
Air Conditioning - Use Of R-12 Refrigerant Substitutes - Service Tip
FORD: 1980-93 CROWN VICTORIA 1981-93 ESCORT 1982-83 FAIRMONT 1982-88 EXP
1982-93 MUSTANG, THUNDERBIRD 1983-86 LTD 1984-93 TEMPO 1986-93 TAURUS 1988-93
FESTIVA 1989-93 PROBE
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1980-93 GRAND MARQUIS, TOWN CAR 1981-87 LYNX 1982-83 LN7,
ZEPHYR 1982-86 CAPRI 1982-93 CONTINENTAL, COUGAR 1983-86 MARQUIS 1984-92 MARK
VII 1984-93 TOPAZ 1986-93 SABLE 1991-93 CAPRI, TRACER
MERKUR: 1986-89 SCORPIO, XR4TI
LIGHT TRUCK: 1980-93 BRONCO, ECONOLINE, F-150-350 SERIES 1983-93 RANGER 1984-90
BRONCO II 1986-93 AEROSTAR 1988-93 F-47 1991-93 EXPLORER 1992-94 F-53 1993
VILLAGER
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK: 1954-90 C SERIES 1970-94 L SERIES 1979-90 CL-9000,
CL-CLT-9000 SERIES 1980-94 F SERIES 1986-94 CARGO SERIES
This TSB is being republished in its entirety to include Heavy Truck models.
ISSUE:
A number of manufacturers are producing refrigerant products which are described as being direct
replacements for refrigerant R-12. The use of any unauthorized substitute refrigerant may severely
damage the A/C system components.
ACTION:
If service is required, use only NEW or RECYCLED refrigerant R-12.
Ford Motor Company has not tested or approved any R-12 refrigerant substitute at this time.
R-134a is approved only for systems which specify R-134a,
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Conditioning - Use of Correct Fluorescent Tracer Dye > Page 585
and is not compatible with R-12 systems.
R-22 likewise, is not compatible with R-12 systems.
CAUTION:
USING ANY UNAUTHORIZED SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT FOR R-12 MAY RESULT IN
SEVERE DAMAGE TO THE A/C SYSTEM COMPONENTS.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 91-9-7
SUPERSEDES: 93-23-11
WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY
OASIS CODES: 208000, 208999, 290000
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 586
Refrigerant: Specifications
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... Refrigerant 12 (R-12) Ford Part Number .............................................
........................................................................................................................................
D4AZ-19B519-A
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Specifications
Compressor ................................................................................................................... 500 viscosity
(C9AZ-19557-B or Motorcraft VN-2 or equivalent)
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 8524 Date: 850124
Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information
Article No. 85-2-4 SEAT/SHOULDER BELTS - GENERAL SERVICE INFORMATION
FORD ALL - 1974-85
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL - 1974-85
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL - 1974-85
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCKS ALL - 1974-85
The States of New York, New Jersey and Illinois recently enacted a mandatory seat belt usage law.
With these laws and impending similar belt usage legislation in other states, dealers can expect
customer inquiries regarding seat belts. The following information is being published in an effort to
refamiliarize dealership service personnel with seat and shoulder belt systems utilized over the
past several model years. Previous Service Recall and TSB articles pertaining to seat belt usage
and servicing are also included.
Section 1 -Identification of Seat Belt System Types For Model Years 1974-1985
There are three distinct types of seat belt systems. Two of the systems are three-point anchoring
systems. One three-point system has dual retractors; one retractor for the lap and one for the
shoulder belt. The other three-point system is the continuous loop single retractor system for the
lap and shoulder belts. The third system is a two-point system that contains a lap belt only which is
used for rear seat and front center passenger restraint.
Continuous Loop Three-Point System The continuous loop system has a moveable tongue on the
front outboard lap/shoulder belt and only one retractor.
Dual Retractor Three-Point System
The dual retractor system has a fixed tongue on the front outboard lap/shoulder belt. (Note that on
the Econoline for 1982-85 model years, the two retractors are on one frame attached to the seat
pedestal.)
Front Center/Rear Seat Two-Point System A 2-point system provides a lap belt only and applies to
the front seat center position and all rear seat positions. Rear outboard belts are equipped with
retractors, while front and rear center belts are not.
A.Continuous Loop Three-Point Shoulder/Lap Belt - System With Moveable Tongue and One
Retractor - 1976 to Present Cars and Ligh
Figure 5
The continuous loop three-point system (Figure 5) is used for front outboard passengers. The
outboard lap/shoulder belt uses a common moveable tongue. To fasten the seat belt, the tongue is
inserted into the inboard buckle. The webbing of the lap belt is anchored to the side of the body
without a
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 596
retractor. The shoulder harness webbing has the other end fixed in a retractor, which is located on
the "B" pillar post or in the quarter panel. The shoulder harness retractor is designed to let the
webbing freely move in or out, except during sufficient vehicle deceleration, when it is automatically
locked by a mechanically actuated inertia sensor. The inboard (buckle) portion of the seat belt
assembly passes between the seat cushion and seat back on bench seat installations, and directly
to a fixed anchorage on the floor. On bucket seat installations, it is routed along the side of the seat
and is fastened to a slide bar. The slide bar is connected to the seat track, the seat, and the floor
pan. On LTD/Marquis and Thunderbird/Cougar, the buckle end passes between the seat and the
consolette and is connected to the seat track.
Attaching the tongue to the buckle secures the occupant with both lower and upper restraints. This
attachment of the tongue and buckle can be accomplished by a single continuous movement. This
system may also include a tension eliminator that is designed to release automatically when the
respective front door is opened. As the seatbelt is unbuckled, the tongue end of the belt should be
hand-guided back to the retractor to prevent the belt tongue from striking occupants or objects
nearby during retraction.
B.Dual Retractor Three-Point Shoulder/Lap System - 1974 to 1983 Cars and Light Trucks and
1974 to 1985 Econolines and Club Wago
Figure 4
The dual retractor three-point system is used for front outboard occupants (Figure 4). The lap belt
portion and shoulder harness are joined at the tongue. To secure the belt, the tongue is inserted
into the buckle of the inboard belt portion.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 597
Figure 4
Figure 6
Except for the 1983-85 Econoline and Club Wagon, the webbing for the outboard lap belt extends
from the belt retractor located on the rocker panel that automatically locks when the belt is being
worn. This locking feature prevents the belt from being pulled out further, but allows the belt to
retract, thus maintaining a snug fit around the user for increased safety. This lap belt retractor is
located on or in the rocker panel (depending on car line and model - Figure 4) or on the seat
pedestal for 1983-85 Econoline and Club Wagon (Figure 6).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 598
Figure 4
The shoulder harness webbing has one end fixed in a retractor (Figure 4) which is located in or on
the rocker panel, or in the "B" pillar post (depending on car/truck line and model). The
Mustang/Capri shoulder harness retractor is located in the quarter panel. From the retractor, the
webbing then passes through a guide above and behind the occupant's shoulder which directs the
webbing at the proper downward angle over the occupant's shoulder and chest, and attaches the
tongue to the inboard belt buckle. The shoulder harness retractor is designed to let the webbing
move freely in or out at all times, except during vehicle deceleration, when the retractor is
automatically locked by a mechanically actuated retractor inertia sensor. The inboard belt buckle
passes through the seat cushion on a bench seat or around the side of the cushion on a bucket
seat to a fixed anchorage on the floor or seat pedestal for Econolines. Attaching (locking together)
the tongue and buckle secures the occupant with both lower and upper restraints. This attachment
of the tongue and buckle can be accomplished by a single continuous movement.
C.Two-Point System - Center Front/Rear and Rear Seat Lap Belts
Those vehicles designed to accommodate a center rear seat occupant have a center lap belt
without a retractor. The belt should be adjusted by the tongue to fit snugly and as low as possible
around the hips.
Figure 6
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 599
Figure 7
In passenger cars and light trucks, the rear seat two-point lap belt system for outboard passengers
has the retractor located in the quarter panel or attached to the floor under the seat (Figure 7). On
Econoline, Club Wagon, Bronco and Bronco II vehicles, the rear seat retractors are attached to the
seat frame or the floor. The buckle portions of the seat belt are all attached to the floor on
passenger cars, and either to the floor or seat frame on Broncos and Econolines. Most rear seat
lap belt retractor assemblies are equipped with a sleeve to prevent the tongue from being lost
between the seat cushion and seat back. The buckle ends pass between the seat cushion and seat
back. On passenger cars, the locking together of the tongue and buckle can be made by a single
continuous movement. On Bronco and Econoline vehicles, the outboard buckle ends pass around
the outside of the rear seat (Figure 6, View B).
Section 3-Functional Test Procedure For Shoulder Harness
Shoulder Harness Functional Test Procedure for Three-Point Systems (Both Dual Retractor and
Continuous Loop Systems)
Driver should buckle up and proceed to a test area appropriate for making sudden stops. If the RH
passenger seat
belt must be tested, a passenger should be buckled into the RH seat. The passenger belt may be
tested utilizing a driver only, providing the driver has the ability to grasp the RH shoulder belt and
extend it approximately (660 mm) 26 inches with no compromise to safe driving. This method
applies to the (8 km/h) 5 mph test only.
NOTE: The RH shoulder belt should not be extended during testing. This avoids the possibility of a
false lock-up that is caused by a fully extended belt.
After reaching an area to safely perform sudden stops, the driver should attain a speed of
approximately (8 km/h) 5 mph. The driver should inform the passenger (if any), that he is preparing
to make a brake application. At this time, both driver and passenger should prepare to lean slightly
forward at the moment the brake application is made.
The driver should make a moderately hard brake application (approximately l6 ft./sec.) without tire
skid. The brake application should be on dry concrete or equivalent hard road surface (never on a
wet or gravel road). The driver and passenger should lean forward slightly into the shoulder
harness; at this instant, the belt retractor should lock-up without webbing payout.
If there is a retractor lock-up on both driver and passenger shoulder straps, the seat belt
assemblies are functioning properly. Should either or both retractors fail to lock-up at the (8 km/h) 5
mph speed, the test should be repeated at a constant (24 km/h) 15 mph. (This test must be
performed with a RH passenger if the RH belt is to be tested.)
If either or both shoulder belt assemblies do not lock-up at the (24 km/h) 15 mph test, the vehicle is
to be returned for removal and replacement of the seat belt assembly, then retest.
WARNING: WHEN REPLACING A SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY, BE SURE TO INSTALL A
COMPLETE NEW ASSEMBLY (BUCKLE PORTION AND TONGUE PORTION TOGETHER) AS
RECEIVED FROM FORD MOTOR COMPANY. DO NOT REPLACE ONE PART OF A SEAT BELT
ASSEMBLY WITHOUT INSTALLING THE ENTIRE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY. THIS WILL ASSURE
THAT THE BUCKLE PORTION IS MANUFACTURED BY THE SAME MANUFACTURER AS THE
TONGUE PORTION AND IS COMPATIBLE WITH IT. ALSO BE SURE THAT THE BELTS
INSTALLED ARE INTENDED SPECIFICALLY FOR THE VEHICLE IN WHICH THEY ARE BEING
INSTALLED.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 600
Section 4-Functional Test Procedure For Lap Belts and Retractor
Webbing Cannot Be Fully Extracted From Lap Belt Retractor - 2-Door and 4-Door (Front Outboard
- Except Versailles)
1. Pull webbing from the shoulder harness retractor, allowing the lap belt to retract fully into the
retractor. Pull webbing from the lap belt retractor, allow it to retract fully.
2. If OK, buckle up while sitting in seat. Repeat five times to ensure proper operation. If not OK,
inspect for webbing twists in the seat belt assembly and remove the twists, if possible, without
dismantling the retractor assembly. Otherwise, replace the seat belt assembly and repeat the
buckle-up procedure five times.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
Lap Belt Retractor Does Not Lock - Dual Retractor 2-Door and 4-Door Models - Front Outboard
Seat (Except Versailles)
1. Withdraw a minimum of 18 inches (460mm) of webbing from the lap belt retractor and check for
lock-up. Retractor must lock-up after 18 inches (460mm) of webbing withdrawal and return of 2
inches (50mm) into retractor and pull out.
2. If the retractor does not lock, replace the entire seat belt assembly and retest.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
Lap Belt Retractor Does Not Lock - Dual Retractor 2-Door and 4-Door Models - Front Outboard
Seat (Versailles Only)
1. Fasten the seat belt. Pull on the lap belt webbing - the retractor should be locked if OK.
Unbuckle, allow the lap belt retractor to fully retract.
2. Repeat Step 1 five (5) times to ensure proper operation.
3. If not OK, replace the seat belt assembly for that seating position and retest.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
NOTE: There are two ways to stop the retractor from "free wheeling". One way is to "buckle up"
and the retractor will lock immediately. The second way is to pull approximately 12" of webbing
from the lap belt retractor, wait approximately 15 seconds, and a thermal timer will deactivate the
"free wheeling" feature.
Webbing Cannot Be Fully Extracted From Lap Belt Retractor
1. If the webbing cannot be pulled from the lap belt retractor, it may be twisted and jammed in a
partially extended position. If the twist can be removed without retractor disassembly, allow the
webbing to fully retract and then withdraw a minimum of 18 inches (460mm) of webbing from the
retractor, return 2 inches (50mm) and check for lock-up. If OK, allow to retract fully and buckle up
while sitting in the seat. Repeat five times to ensure proper operation. Verify that belt webbing can
be extended far enough to expose the manufacturer's certification label.
2. If not OK, replace the seat belt assembly and repeat appropriate portions of Step 1, above.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
Figure 7
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 601
Seats - Rear - Lap Belt Retractor Does Not Lock - 2-Point System (Figure 7)
1. Withdraw a minimum of 18 inches (460mm) of webbing from lap belt retractor and check for
lock-up. Retractor must lock-up after 18 inches (460mm) of webbing withdrawn and return of 2
inches (50mm) into retractor and pull out.
If OK, allow it to retract fully and buckle up while sitting in the seat. Repeat five times to ensure
proper operation.
2. If not OK, replace seat belt assembly and repeat Step 1.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
3. If the retractor of a new seat belt assembly has been bolted into a damaged or distorted
mounting area, the new retractor could be warped and may not function. If this is the case, service
the sheet metal in the area of the retractor mounting and install a new belt assembly.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
Buckle Does Not Latch - All Belts
If the tongue will not latch into the buckle securely, a coin or other foreign object may be interfering
with proper buckle operation. Remove the object, if possible, and recheck for secure latching. If not
OK, replace the belt assembly.
REMEMBER, A COMPLETE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY MUST ALWAYS BE INSTALLED AS
NOTED IN THE WARNING STATEMENT IN SECTIONS 3 AND 7 OF THIS ARTICLE!
Section 5-Seat Belt Procedure After an Accident
NOTE: ALL SEAT BELT ASSEMBLIES INCLUDING RETRACTORS AND ATTACHING
HARDWARE SHOULD BE INSPECTED AFTER ANY COLLISION. FORD RECOMMENDS THAT
ALL SEAT BELT ASSEMBLIES IN USE DURING A COLLISION BE REPLACED UNLESS THE
COLLISION WAS MINOR AND THE BELTS SHOW NO DAMAGE AND CONTINUE TO
OPERATE PROPERLY. SEAT BELT ASSEMBLIES NOT IN USE DURING A COLLISION
SHOULD ALSO BE INSPECTED AND REPLACED IF EITHER DAMAGE OR IMPROPER
OPERATION IS NOTED.
Before installing the new seat belt assembly, the seat belt attaching areas must be inspected for
damage and distortion, and if the attaching points are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal must
be reworked back to its original shape and structural integrity.
Install the new seat belt assembly in matched sets using the appropriate instructions; then
functionally test as described previously in this article.
Section 6-Cleaning Belt Webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any mild soap solution recommended for cleaning upholstery or
carpets; follow instructions provided with the soap. Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing because it
may weaken the belt webbing.
Section 7-Service Parts
The Ford Motor Company stocks replacement parts for all passenger car safety belt systems for
which there is nominal demand without regard to the age of vehicle. Beyond this, in the interest of
ensuring that the full protection of safety belts is available for all Ford owners, the Company will
undertake to provide parts to service the belt system for any Company vehicle if it was originally
equipped with safety belts.
Seat belt and shoulder assembly part numbers for specific applications can be identified by
referring to Body Section 611 of the parts catalog. In general, these assemblies are available with
black webbing only once the vehicle is beyond two years out of production. Part orders should be
placed through the normal PDC system.
WARNING: WHEN REPLACING A SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY, BE SURE TO INSTALL A
COMPLETE NEW ASSEMBLY (BUCKLE PORTION AND TONGUE PORTION TOGETHER) AS
RECEIVED FROM FORD MOTOR COMPANY. DO NOT REPLACE ONE PART OF A SEAT BELT
ASSEMBLY WITHOUT INSTALLING THE ENTIRE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY. THIS WILL ASSURE
THAT THE BUCKLE PORTION IS MANUFACTURED BY THE SAME MANUFACTURER AS THE
TONGUE PORTION AND IS COMPATIBLE WITH IT. ALSO BE SURE THAT THE BELTS
INSTALLED ARE INTENDED SPECIFICALLY FOR THE VEHICLE IN WHICH THEY ARE BEING
INSTALLED.
QUICK REFERENCE PARTS LISTING FOR SEAT BELTS, COMFORT CLIPS, AND
EXTENDERS
Extenders offer eight inches of additional length and can be used in all seating positions. It is
necessary to ensure that the manufacturer of the extender being installed is the same as that
identified on the seat belt assembly. Part numbers for comfort clips used in the 3-point system, seat
belts, extenders are shown below.
Quick Reference Part Listing
Book Microfiche
Section Page Plate Row Column
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Seat/Shoulder Belts - General Service Information > Page 602
Car Seat Belt Extenders
1973-1979 611 2 F4 10 01
and Seat Belts 1973-1979 611 2 M4 9 56
1980- 611 1 F3 23 47
1980- 611 1 M3 23 47
Truck Seat Belt Extenders
1973-1979 600 3 LT2 20 48
and Seat Belts 1980- 600 4 LT2 11 04
All Vehicles Comfort Clips
1973-1979 600 8 F4 9 63
Section 8-Service Recalls Involving Seat Belts
Recall # Letter Dated Year Car Line Concern
H1B 11/17/1971 1972 Pinto, T-Bird, Light Truck Seat belt or shoulder belt bolt fracture
C-2H 7/10/1972 1972 Mark IV Belt retractor won't lock up
H-2H 7/10/1972 1972 Thunderbird Belt retractor won't lock up
C-3E 7/31/1972 1972 Montego Belt retractor won't lock up
H-3E 7/31/1972 1972 Torino Belt retractor won't lock up
H-3F 7/31/1972 71-72 F-Series Lt. & Med. Incorrect length shoulder belt - no adjustment
H-9D 6/1973 1973 Ford, Pinto, Lt. Truck Seat belt bolt fracture
118 3/20/1974 1974 Torino Retractor remains unlocked
130 8/26/1974 1975 Mercury Mixed part assys. - no seat belt latching
152 2/14/1975 1972 Maverick, Comet Need longer belts
189 4/26/1976 1976 W-Series Belt too short
214 12/4/1976 76-77 Granada, Monarch Shoulder belt weld nut replacement
253 2/22/1978 72-78 L8OO/900, L8000/9000 Belt too short
282 3/30/1978 1978 Pinto, Bobcat, Mustang II Retractor won't lock up
289 8/29/1978 1978 T-Bird, Cougar, LTD II, Ford Retractor won't lock up
298 9/20/1978 1978 F-Series Weld nut replacement
313 10/25/1978 1979 Econolines Possible cut belt by the seat
1536 11/1/1978 1979 Versailles Retractor solenoid drawing constant
current, discharging battery
458 3/30/1983 81-82 Escort, Lynx Wagon Shoulder belt anchorage reinforcement
477 12/12/1983 1984 Escort/Lynx (3 dr.), Tempo/ D-ring bolt replacement
Topaz (2 dr.), Mustang/Capri, T-Bird/Cougar, LTD/Marquis, Mark VII, Continental, Ford/ Mercury,
Lincoln, Ranger, Bronco II, Bronco 477-S
2/23/1984 1984 Bronco, Bronco II, Ranger D-ring covers
489 8/8/1984 81-84 Escort/Lynx, Tempo/Topaz Belt protective spacers
Section 9-TSB's Involving Seat Belts
TSB # Title Other Information
198 Unauthorized Service Replace belt assembly
81-2-6 Securing Tot Guard Seat belt extender
81-5-3 Seat Belt Discoloration (Red) Truck, Escort/Lynx 1981
81-7-23 Seat Belt Becomes Tight While Driving Seat belt replacement
83-18-15 Seat Belt Rattles Against Trim Seat belt replacement
84-4-4 D-Ring Bind - Restricts Extraction of Belt Addition of spacer
84-11-1 D-Ring Cover Bind - Belt Free Swing D-ring cover replacement
41-50-8 See following page
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Latch > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Safety Belt - Tongue Cover Now Available
Seat Belt Latch: Technical Service Bulletins Safety Belt - Tongue Cover Now Available
SAFETY BELT - TONGUE COVER SERVICE PART
AVAILABILITY
Article No. 88-25-2
FORD: 1974-88 ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1974-88 ALL
LIGHT-TRUCK: 1974-88 ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY: 1974-88
ISSUE: The safety belt tongue cover is now available for service. It is no longer necessary to
replace the entire safety belt assembly in the event a buckle and tongue cover requires service.
ACTION: No corrective action is required. Refer to the following application chart for the correct
service part number.
NOTE: THE SAFETY BELT TONGUE COVERS ARE SERVICED IN A NEUTRAL COLOR AND
MUST BE PAINTED TO MATCH.
SAFETY BELT TONGUE COVER APPLICATION CHART MODEL YEAR
VEHICLE SERVICE PART NO.
1986-88 Taurus/Sable E7DZ-54612A64-A
1974-88 All Other Vehicles E7FZ-61612A64-A
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
E7DZ-54612A64-A Safety Belt Tongue Cover Package of 4
BM
E7FZ-61612A64-A Safety Belt Tongue Cover Package of 4
B
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS:
"INFORMATION ONLY"
OASIS CODES: 1050, 1051, 1800
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Antitheft Devices - Installation Precautions
Antitheft and Alarm Systems: Technical Service Bulletins Antitheft Devices - Installation
Precautions
Article No. 86-3-9
ANTI-THEFT DEVICES (AFTER MARKET) - INSTALLATION/ OPERATING PRECAUTIONS ON
VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ELECTRONIC ENGINE CONTROLS (EEC)
FORD 1978-86 ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1978-86 ALL
LIGHT TRUCK 1981-86 ALL
NOTE: This article is being republished in its entirety to include 1986 models.
Installation of "AfterMarket" anti-theft devices such as fuel shutoff and ignition defeating devices
may cause no starts, hard starting, stalls, or damage to vehicle components on Ford vehicles
equipped with electronic engine controls. Possible damage caused by these devices can result
from the following situations:
1. Fuel shutoff devices - Attempting to start the vehicle without disarming this device may cause the
fuel injectors to run dry and overheat, which will lead to failure of the injectors.
2. Ignition defeating devices which ground the ignition/tachometer lead - Attempting to start the
vehicle without disarming may result in ignition coil failure.
Figure 13
In addition, care must be taken when routing underhood after market wiring (see Figure 13 for
proper precautions), in order to avoid electromagnetic interference with electronic engine controls.
The following precautions must be observed:
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Antitheft Devices - Installation Precautions > Page 612
1. Ignition tach signal wiring must not be randomly routed through the engine compartment.
2. Add-on wiring must not run parallel to secondary (plug) ignition wires.
3. EEC wiring harness (12A581) must not be altered or cut or rerouted.
Failure to observe these warnings may result in damage to vehicle components or drive
deterioration. OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: Supersedes 85-7-8 WARRANTY STATUS:
"INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition - Coil Durability/Radio Frequency Interference
Radio/Stereo: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition - Coil Durability/Radio Frequency Interference
Article No. 84-22-8
IGNITION - COIL DURABILITY AND RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE
LIGHT TRUCKS 1985 AND PRIOR YEARS - ALL SERIES
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCKS 1985 AND PRIOR YEARS - ALL SERIES
Relocation of the ignition coil to accomodate the installation of non-Ford engine-mounted
equipment may effect the durability of the coil and/or cause a radio frequency interference
condition. For these reasons movement of the ignition coil from its original location is not
recommended.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures
Paint: Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures
Article No. 84-3-3
PAINT - COSMETIC SURFACE SERVICE PROCEDURES
FORD ALL CAR LINES - ALL MODEL YEARS
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL CAR LINES - ALL MODEL YEARS
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL SERIES - ALL MODEL YEARS
The cosmetic paint surface service procedures outlined below are reprinted from Article Number
82-3-3 dated February 18, 1982. Many of these procedures and techniques described have been
incorporated along with several other helpful procedures in a video tape which is now available.
This video tape describes paint and soft facia service procedures developed by Ford Motor
Company Assembly plants to correct minor concerns. After seeing the video tape and with practice,
a technician or body shop employee should be able to do the following:
^ Remove most minor dings and dents (without filling and repainting), by using special metal
massaging service tools.
^ Remove hood and deck depressions without filling and repainting.
^ Remove trapped dirt particles and still preserve the original paint finish.
^ Service minor scratches that do not cut through into the prime or metal.
^ Service orange peel without repainting.
^ Service sags and runs without repainting.
^ Remove surface stains with a heat gun.
^ Make soft facia services on many punctures and tears in plastic parts without replacement.
^ Service damaged abrasion resistant coating.
^ Properly paint over E-coating.
The video tape is titled, "Cosmetic Paint and Surface Repairs" and is available in 3/4 inch Umatic
UMC, Order Number 4651-025; or 1/2 inch VHS, Order Number 4651-025.
For ordering information refer to the Ford Service Training Aids Catalog or write to:
Ford Service Publications Post Office Box 07150 Detroit, Michigan 48207
Exterior paint surface damage or imperfections of a nature where the prime coat does not show
can, in most instances, be restored without repainting. The restoration of gloss and luster after the
condition has been removed is made possible by new and improved service materials and
procedures. The following procedure is applicable to surface conditions such as dirt particles,
orange peel, runs, sags, industrial fallout stains, swirl marks, light scratches and other minor
imperfections. Usually, these conditions are localized and it is not necessary to restore the entire
panel. However, in a case such as dirt particles or scratches in several localized areas, it is
recommended that the entire panel be restored to maintain a uniform appearance.
FIGURE 5
Preparation
Before starting the service, the affected surface must be clean and dry. Mask off adjacent panels,
mouldings, stripes and character lines as required (Figure 5). Where applicable, eye protection,
face mask and a belt buckle cover should be worn.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 624
Service Procedure
The basic concept of the procedure is to remove the defect condition, and then restore the finish to
an acceptable appearance. As a general guideline, remember that sanding marks are removed
with rubbing compound and the swirl marks evident after buffing are removed by polishing. As an
example, light scratches or small dirt particles can be removed with a power buffer and medium
buffing compound followed by polishing. Deeper scratches, heavy dirt particles or orange peel must
be wet sanded, buffed with compound to remove the sanding marks and then polished to remove
the swirl marks from the buffing operation.
It is suggested with initial service attempts, that technicians develop a learning cycle by picking a
small service area and first try polishing, then buffing and finally wet sanding to remove the
condition. When you have determined which method is appropriate, proceed with the remaining
area to be serviced and then restore the finish as required. The following outlines the complete
procedure and required materials.
FIGURE 6
Polishing
For removal of very minor scratches, swirl marks and/or to restore luster to a dull finish.
Apply a small amount of 3M Final Glaze to the affected panel (Figure 6) and using a suitable
electric or air powered polish/buffing wheel (2000 max. rpm) and a 3M Superbuff 2 + 2 Pad, polish
the affected area until all swirl marks are gone and desired luster is obtained. When polishing, keep
the pad flat against the surface. Do not bear down, the weight of the buffer is sufficient. Add Final
Glaze sparingly as needed. Compound
For removal of light scratches, small dirt particles, minor grind marks and sanding marks.
FIGURE 7
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 625
FIGURE 8
Apply 3M Superduty Rubbing Compound (medium) to the panel and using a clean 2 + 2 pad on the
wheel (as noted above) spread the compound evenly and buff the surface until the condition is
removed; or in the case of a sanded area, the sanding marks are gone and the luster is restored to
an acceptable level for polishing (Figure 7 and Figure 8). When buffing, keep the wheel flat to the
surface using light to moderate pressure and long even strokes. Periodically check the finish and
add compound as required. When buffing is complete, polish the panel as described above.
Sanding
For removal of severe conditions such as heavy dirt particles, deep scratches and orange peel.
This wet sanding procedure utilizes 3M Ultra Fine Imperial Wetordry Color Sanding Paper to
facilitate removal of surface damage. The Ultra Fine paper cuts quickly leaving a uniform finish that
requires a minimum of buffing to restore the luster.
FIGURE 9
1. Soak the 3M Imperial Wetordry Paper and a 3M Imperial Wetordry Sponge Pad thoroughly in
clean water and wrap the paper around the pad as shown in Figure 9.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 626
FIGURE 10
2. Using a clean sponge, wet the area to be sanded. It is essential that the paper be kept wet as
sanding proceeds (Figure 10).
FIGURE 11
3. Wet sand the affected area with light even pressure on the pad with back and forth strokes (not
circular). Do a small area at a time (Figure 11).
FIGURE 12
4. Frequently dip the pad and paper in water to wash off sanding residue (Figure 12).
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 627
FIGURE 13
5. Frequently flood or squeegee off the affected surface to check depth of cut and to see if the
defect is removed. The amount of paint surface that is being sanded can be judged as the area
dulls (Figure 13).
FIGURE 14
6. Water wash the affected area to determine if all surface defects have been removed. Note the
uniform dull appearance of an evenly sanded panel (Figure 14). If the surface is not uniform, lightly
resand the area.
FIGURE 15
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 628
7. Wash and squeegee off the panel and check to assure that all defects are removed and sanding
is complete. Then proceed with the buffing and polish procedures to restore the luster to the finish.
8. Figure 15 shows a hood panel which has been sanded, buffed and polished on one section to
illustrate the effectiveness of the procedure.
Runs and Sags
The service of runs and sags in nonmetallic paint is covered in the previously released training
publication "The Wet Look." This procedure, which consists of shaving the run or sag flush with a
commercial single edge razor blade, sanding with a hard block and then compounding, can now be
improved by finishing the service with Final Glaze. It is recommended that minor sags and runs be
wet sanded with 600 grit paper. If it is necessary to shave them off with a razor blade, first dull the
corners with sandpaper to avoid scratching the adjacent panel finish.
PART NUMBER PART NAME CLASS
05528 3M Imperial Wetordry Sponge Pad
02021 3M Imperial Wetordry Color
Sanding Paper
05955 3M Superduty Rubbing
Compound
05957 3M Superduty Paste Compound
(if preferred)
05701 3M Superbuff 2 + 2 Pad
05710 3M Superbuff Adaptor (if req'd)
05988 3M Final Glaze
02024 3M Wetordry Tri-M-ite Paper 600 Grit
05519 3M Sanding Block
7" Polisher/Buffer Air or Electric Razor Blade - Industrial Single Edge
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 82-3-3 WARRANTY STATUS: Reimbursable within the
provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual. OPERATION: SPP6282 TIME:
One Panel 0.4 Hr. - Each additional 0.2 Hr. MATERIAL ALLOWANCE: $.75 per panel DLR.
CODING: Basic Part No. As applicable
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 629
Paint: Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Cosmetic Damage From Airborn Materials
PAINT COSMETIC DAMAGE FROM AIRBORN MATERIALS Article No. 89-13-3 FORD:
1989 and prior ALL FORD LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1989 and prior ALL LINCOLN-MERCURY LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1989 and prior ALL LIGHT TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: Paint may be damaged from various sources of airborn materials. The two different types
are:
^ Inorganic
^ Organic
Sometimes it is hard to identify the type of paint damage and know how to remove it. This TSB
article gives detailed information and descriptions of both types of airborn materials. It also outlines
the service procedures for treating them.
ACTION: If service is required, identify the source of damage involved by referring to the following
information. Use the following recommended service procedure to correct concerns.
INORGANIC AIRBORN MATERIAL
The effects of inorganic airborn materials can be seen as:
^ Dark blotches in the paint where the pigment in the paint surface has been attacked
^ Irregular spots that are cracked or etched around the edges and dull in the centers.
^ Small orange colored spots caused by iron particles may appear on the paint surface.
Generally, materials that attack a paint film are either acidic or alkaline in nature.
Sulfuric and nitric acids, in general, cause extreme damage to automative paint finishes. Even very
small concentrations of the same materials can cause chemical spotting damage. Due to
evaporation and condensation, these acids can create severe etching "spots" that may eventually
crack or lift the paint film after some time in service.
Although some automotive finishes are more resistant than others, none are completely immune to
these chemicals. The most resistant paints used today are the urethanes because their resin
system is least likely to react with chemicals. Air dry coatings are more susceptible to attack only
when they are fresh. The longer the paint dries the more resistant it becomes.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 630
Metallic colors are more intolerant to chemicals because aluminum flake is fairly reactive with either
an acid or alkali. The following chart contains the most common acid materials found on automotive
finishes. The chart shows a color, the corresponding damage appearance and also the chemical
causal agent. It is not applicable for Basecoat/Clearcoat finishes.
* "Caustic" refers to any alkaline substance that may be "harsh" or "corrosive" depending on
strength or concentration.
The following "pH" chart show the relationship between acidic and alkaline chemicals and their
corresponding pH values. This chart is provided for informational reference only. ORGANIC
AIRBORN MATERIALS
Organic damage is generally easier to identify. Organic damage is mostly due to tree sap, bird and
insect droppings, dead insects (Figure 8) and pollen. Tree sap is easily identified by clear raised
drops that may be hard or sticky. Bee or bug dropping spots may appear brownish or yellow in
color, about an eighth to a quarter inch in diameter. Dead and decomposing insect bodies are
readily visible to the eye. Pollen deposits are small yellow clusters. Each of these items is
potentially damaging to any currently available paint system. Other noticeable traits of organic
damage are spots that are raised (swelling) micro-crazing (cracked) and pitting, due to pollen
eating into the paint film. The active ingredients in most organic contaminants are tannic and formic
acids . These acids are found in berries and bodily fluids of insects and birds.
Investigations completed at dealerships show that the bright lot lights tend to attract insects. The
use of "soft lights" for display and storage lot illumination will help reduce damage resulting from
decomposing bugs and droppings by decreasing the number of bugs attracted to these lights.
Organic damage is accelerated by heat. During very hot weather conditions, it is important to wash
vehicles more often.
ORGANIC AND INORGANIC REPAIR PROCEDURES FOR MILD DAMAGE
Iron dust particles may imbed themselves into the paint film. On some light colored vehicles after
some weathering, tiny dots of rust start to appear. They
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 631
feel rough to the touch and are difficult to remove. The best way to remove these particles is by
treating the finish with an oxalic acid-detergent-water wash. Use the following procedure to perform
this service repair.
NOTE: OXALIC ACID WASH IS ALSO PRE-PACKAGED IN VARIOUS STRENGTHS UNDER
VARIOUS BRAND NAMES, IF YOU CHOOSE NOT TO MIX YOUR OWN BATCHES.
1. Wash and degrease the vehicle first, using Ford Multi Purpose Cleaner (B8A-19523-B) or
equivalent, and a suitable wax and grease remover. If this does not remove all of the iron particles,
proceed with the oxalic acid wash.
2. Prepare a quantity of oxalic acid-detergent-water solution as follows:
a. Dissolve 6-8 ounces of Oxalic Acid (powder) in one gallon of warm water.
b. Add 1-2 tablespoons full of non-alkaline detergent such as Ford Multi Purpose Cleaner.
3. Apply this solution liberally to all affected surfaces of the vehicle with a large sponge. Keep the
surface wet until the technician can no longer feel any surface roughness with bare or gloved
fingertips.
NOTE: IF THIS IS NOT DONE THOROUGHLY, STAINING MAY REDEVELOP IF IRON
PARTICLES ARE LEFT BEHIND.
4. Rinse the area with clean water.
CAUTION: FAILURE TO THOROUGHLY RINSE THIS SURFACE COULD RESULT IN
CORROSION OF ANODIZED ALUMINUM OR
STAINLESS STEEL PARTS WITH PROLONGED CONTACT.
5. If the iron particles are not totally removed after 2 washings, use one or both of the procedures
listed for minor chemical contamination.
NOTE: THE USE OF POLISHING (WITH WAX), SANDING WITH MICRO FINE SANDPAPER
(1500 GRIT OR GREATER) OR BUFFING WITH VERY LIGHT COMPOUND SHOULD ONLY BE
DONE AS A LAST RESORT.
CHEMICAL CONTAMINATION
Chemical contamination, either acid or alkali, can cause off-color spots and crack the paint film. In
the presence of moisture (dew), sulfur contamination will change the color (light/dark) of the paint
pigments. (This does not apply to Basecoat/Clearcoat)
Since this contamination affects the pigments, lacquers and enamels show no difference in
resistance. Production thermal drying and air drying finishes are likely to be spotted.
Minor chemical contamination can be removed by using the following step by step procedure.
1. Wash the vehicle first by using Ford Multi Purpose Cleaner (B8A-19523-B) or equivalent to
remove the exterior foreign materials.
2. If the spotting is extensive and on the horizontal surfaces, then machine polish.
3. Apply a light grit polishing compound to the affected surface by using a soft brush. The
compound should be applied to a small area at a time so that it can be buffed out while still wet to
get maximum cutting efficiency.
4. Polish off the spots using a buffer operating at 1700-1800 rpm. Confine polishing to the spotted
areas. Repeat as necessary until all spots have been removed.
5. Remove spots on curved surfaces, near edges, and next to mouldings or ornaments by hand
polishing as follows:
a. Apply some polishing compound to a cotton cloth. (Do not use a synthetic cloth.)
b. Rub vigorously until the spots are no longer visible.
c. Clean off excess polishing compound by using a clean cloth and compressed air.
6. Buff out the polishing marks and bring up the gloss by using a buffer equipped with a clean, dry
lambs wool pad.
NOTE: IF POLISHING DOES NOT SUFFICIENTLY REMOVE DAMAGE, THE VEHICLE CAN BE
WET SANDED USING 1500 GRIT SANDPAPER AND THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE
Wet Sanding Procedure
1. Clean the exterior surface of the vehicle with Ford Multi Purpose cleaner or an equivalent to
remove all contamination.
2. Apply 1500 grit sandpaper to a rubber padded sanding block to sand the paint surface.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 632
3. Use a squirt bottle filled with water to lubricate the 1500 grit sandpaper as you begin to sand only
the damaged areas. Water is an abrasive as well as a lubricant in this step.
NOTE: IF THE DAMAGE HAS GONE DEEPLY INTO THE PAINT FILM AND IT WILL NOT
POLISH OR SAND OUT, THEN REFINISHING IS REQUIRED.
ORGANIC MATERIAL REPAIR PROCEDURE FOR MILD DAMAGE
Minor organic damage can be removed by using the following step by step procedure.
1. Wash and degrease the vehicle thoroughly by using Ford Multi Purpose Cleaner (B8A-19523-B)
or equivalent and a wax and grease remover to remove all organics.
2. Inspect the vehicle horizontal surfaces. If spotting or paint film swelling is extensive, use a buffer
to repair.
3. Apply a light grit polishing compound to the affected areas by using a soft brush. The compound
should be applied to a small area at a time so that it can be buffed out while still wet to get
maximum efficiency.
4. Polish off the spots or swelling marks using a buffer that operates between 1700-1800 rpm.
Polishing should be confined to the affected areas only. Repeat as necessary until all spots or
marks are removed.
5. Remove spots on curved surfaces, near edges, and next to mouldings or ornaments by hand
polishing as follows:
a. Apply some polishing compound to a cotton cloth. (Do not use a synthetic cloth.)
b. Rub vigorously until the spots are no longer visible.
c. Clean off excess polishing compound by using a clean cloth and compressed air.
6. Buff out the polishing marks and bring up the gloss by using a buffer equipped with a clean, dry
lambs wool pad.
NOTE: IF POLISHING DOES NOT SUFFICIENTLY REMOVE DAMAGE, THE VEHICLE CAN BE
WET SANDED USING 1500 GRIT SANDPAPER AND THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE.
Wet Sanding Procedure
1. Clean the exterior surface of the vehicle with Ford Multi Purpose cleaner or an equivalent to
remove all organics.
2. Apply 1500 grit sandpaper to a rubber padded sanding block to sand the paint surface.
3. Use a squirt bottle filled with water to lubricate the 1500 grit sandpaper as you begin to sand only
the damaged areas. Water is an abrasive as well as a lubricant in this step.
NOTE: IF THE DAMAGE HAS GONE DEEPLY INTO THE PAINT FILM AND IT WILL NOT
POLISH OUT, THEN REFINISHING IS REQUIRED.
PAINT RECONDITIONING PROCEDURES FOR SEVERE DAMAGE
Acrylic enamel single stage or base/clear paint systems should be painted by using the following
procedure.
1. .Wash the vehicle with Ford Multi Purpose Cleaner or equivalent to remove all organic materials.
2. Wash the areas to be painted with wax and grease remover.
3. Prepare the area as follows:
a. Neutralize the affected areas with baking soda (sodium bicarbonate) and water.
b. Rinse the surface off with plain water.
c. Wash the panel with a mild soapy detergent.
d. Dry the panel completely.
NOTE: IF THE DAMAGE IS THROUGH THE TOP COAT FINISH AND INTO THE PRIMERS, THE
PANEL MUST BE SANDED DOWN TO BARE METAL OR PLASTIC AND THEN REFINISHED.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Paint - Cosmetic Surface Service Procedures > Page 633
4. Apply a self-etching primer for metal surfaces only.
NOTE: A FLEX ADDITIVE MAY BE NECESSARY WHEN WORKING WITH FLEXIBLE PLASTICS
Then proceed as follows:
a. Let dry per instructions.
b. Apply a two component urethane primer surfacer.
c. Sand the surface with 400 grit sandpaper to get to proper finish.
d. Finish sanding with 600 grit sandpaper.
5. Solvent wash panel with wax and grease remover. Then, tack wipe it.
6. Apply base coat or top coat material per applicable paint system.
NOTE: THE USE OF ACRYLIC URETHANE ENAMEL IS HIGHLY RECOMMENDED FOR THIS
TYPE OF REPAIR.
7. Apply clear acrylic urethane if you are using a base/clear paint system.
WAYS TO MINIMIZE EFFECTS OF AIRBORN MATERIAL DAMAGE
During the past year, Ford Motor Company and major paint suppliers have participated in a survey
to analyze the effects of airborn materials. This survey was conducted on foreign and domestic
vehicles. It resulted in the following interesting conclusions.
1. Keeping the vehicles clean, washing frequently with de-ionized water and drying by hand or
mechanical means will help minimize the effects of inorganic and organic materials.
2. Spray washing without rubbing will not totally remove all residue on the surface of the vehicle.
Damage could possibly occur over a longer period of time.
3. Care should be taken to not allow any painted vehicle surface to become wet in direct sunlight.
(A sprinkler system can cause damage if the vehicles are not dried.) Possible alkaline water or
mineral deposit may be the cause.
4. The use of "Soft Lights" for lighting around storage lots and showing areas will minimize the
attraction of insects and the possibility of organic damage.
5. Ford Motor Company is piloting a program for a transit/storage coating to be applied on the
horizontal surfaces of all vehicles. These coatings have shown good protection to the paint surface.
They are clear in color and should be left on the vehicles until they are sold.
6. We are testing many "permanent paint sealants" used by dealers. Until all testing is completed,
we cannot give any recommendations for what products to use. Testing has shown that a sealant
that allows water to bead up on the vehicle does not help to dissipate the materials on the paint
surface. Sheeting of water on the vehicle is highly desirable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: INFORMATION ONLY OASIS
CODES:
1100
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Speed Control - New
Rotunda Tester Information
Cruise Control: Technical Service Bulletins Speed Control - New Rotunda Tester Information
Article No. 85-1-8 SPEED CONTROL - NEW ROTUNDA TESTER INFORMATION FORD
1974-1985
LINCOLN-MERCURY 1974-1985
LIGHT TRUCKS 1974-1985
Figure 5 - Article No. 85-1-8
A new Rotunda #007-00013 speed control tester is now available for functioning and diagnosing all
Ford factory installed speed control systems from 1974 through 1985 model year for both
passenger cars
and light trucks.
The tester (Figure 5) works on vehicles with all combinations of control switches, transmissions,
speedometers (electronic and mechanical), brakes, clutches, etc. With three modes of operation
(Automatic, Single Scan, and Scan Probe), the mechanic
can pinpoint any failure including wiring, vacuum lines, switches, servos, etc.
The tester includes a manual with its own specially developed "diagnostic trees" for identifying any
failed or marginal part in the speed control system. Service technicians with little or no experience
with speed control systems can use this tester to efficiently service the systems.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > EGR Maintenance Light > Component
Information > Service and Repair
EGR Maintenance Light: Service and Repair
EGR Warning Switch Reset
NOTE:
After performing the necessary EGR system maintenance, the EGR warning lamp switch can be
reset. The switch is installed behind the speedometer and is reset as follows:
Procedure
1. Remove cover from switch.
2. Slide the switch knob to the opposite position and the warning lamp will go out.
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings
Odometer: Technical Service Bulletins Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings
SPEEDOMETER - MECHANICAL/ELECTRONIC - INACCURATE SPEED READINGS AND
ODOMETER READINGS
Article No. 89-2-7
FORD: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL CAR LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL CAR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: The accuracy of speedometer/odometer readings may be influenced by several vehicle
components or systems. The information in this TSB article is intended to assist technicians in
speedometer/odometer concern diagnosis.
ACTION: Use the following supplemental information below to assist in speedometer/odometer
diagnostics.
OPERATION
A mechanical analog speedometer displays vehicle speed and the odometer displays total distance
traveled. The speedometer/odometer assembly is cable driven by either a transmission or a
transaxle. All speedometer/odometer assemblies, except for police vehicles are the same with
respect to the speed accuracy tolerance used during calibration. The odometer gear ratio is fixed
so that all are identical and have no error in the speedometer head.
Electronic digital operation is similar. It could use a drive cable or a speed sensor to drive the
speedometer/odometer. An electronic signal is sent from a speed sensor to the digital
speedometer/ odometer assembly. The speed sensor is driven by a transmission or a transaxle,
similar to a cable.
Several areas of concern that may affect speedometer/ odometer readings are tires, axle gear ratio
and speedometer/odometer drive and driven gears.
TIRES
Improper tire rolling radius and inflation pressure, temperature and size may contribute to
inaccurate system readings. System accuracy testing should be performed after the tires are set at
the correct pressure as shown on the safety compliance certification label. The tires should be
warmed for a short period. Best results are obtained on smooth, dry pavement while driving at a
constant speed within the posted speed limit.
AXLE/TRANSAXLE RATIO
The gear ratio of the rear axle or the final drive ratio of the transaxle must be known to select or
check if the proper speedometer/odometer drive and driven gears are present. Various gear ratios
are available, but usually are not a concern when dealing with speedometer/odometer concerns
unless the gear ratio has been changed.
WARNING: NEVER CORRECT SPEEDOMETER READINGS BY CHANGING GEARS UNLESS
THE ODOMETER IS ALSO OFF. DRIVE/DRIVEN GEARS
The speedometer/odometer drive gear is located inside the transmission, transaxle or transfer case
and is not easily accessed for change. The driven gear rotates the speedometer cable. Rear wheel
drive vehicles have several driven gears with various numbers of teeth available to correct input to
the speedometer/odometer head. Front wheel drive vehicles generally do not offer different gears
for correction.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The maximum allowable odometer system accuracy error is +/- 3.75% of the actual distance
traveled. Ford Motor vehicles are well within those limits.
The speed indication is biased high, except on police vehicles with certified calibration
speedometers/ odometers. As a general rule, the indicated speed is equal to or greater than the
actual speed. This is intended to protect the consumer against violating speed laws. Most customer
concerns are related to speedometers reading too high at true speeds between 50 MPH and 65
MPH (80 - 105 Km/h). At that speed range, the worst case errors may indicate a speed that is 10%
greater than true speed.
The speedometer head is an instrument which processes information sent to it by the rotating
speedometer cable. If the system components send the
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings > Page 646
wrong number of revolution per mile to the speedometer head, an inaccurate speed reading and
amount of distanced traveled will be displayed. Since there is no error in the fixed gear ratio of the
speedometer head odometer, start by checking the accuracy of the odometer even if the customer
concern indicates a speed accuracy problem. Odometer accuracy can be checked by using roads
established at mile increments or a known local course. If roads with mile markers are used, a five
mile stretch is recommended to allow for inaccuracies. If an error is greater than 3.75%, a change
to the transmission drive/driven gear selection, tire size, or tire inflation may need attention. The
odometer should be checked again to verify any corrective action. If the indicated speed error
exceeds 10% between 50 MPH and 60 MPH (80 - 105 Km/h), replace the speedometer/odometer
assembly. Vehicles with transfer cases that have fluctuating readings may be due to slippage of
drive gears, parts not splined or loose yoke nuts.
If the vehicle has speed control, the speed accuracy can be checked using the verified odometer
vs. time. The formula is as follows:
3600 divided by TIME (seconds to cover one mile) = TRUE MPH (Km/h) EXAMPLES:
60 MPH (96 Km/h) requires 60 seconds to cover one mile
55 MPH (88 Km/h) requires 65 and 3/4 seconds to cover one mile
50 MPH (80 Km/h) requires 72 seconds to cover one mile
ARTICLE SUPERSEDED: 84-14-6, date 7/3/84
WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
OASIS CODES: 2300, 2310, 2400, 2500
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings
Speedometer Head: Technical Service Bulletins Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings
SPEEDOMETER - MECHANICAL/ELECTRONIC - INACCURATE SPEED READINGS AND
ODOMETER READINGS
Article No. 89-2-7
FORD: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL CAR LINES
LINCOLN-MERCURY: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL CAR LINES
LIGHT TRUCK: 1989 AND PRIOR ALL TRUCK LINES
ISSUE: The accuracy of speedometer/odometer readings may be influenced by several vehicle
components or systems. The information in this TSB article is intended to assist technicians in
speedometer/odometer concern diagnosis.
ACTION: Use the following supplemental information below to assist in speedometer/odometer
diagnostics.
OPERATION
A mechanical analog speedometer displays vehicle speed and the odometer displays total distance
traveled. The speedometer/odometer assembly is cable driven by either a transmission or a
transaxle. All speedometer/odometer assemblies, except for police vehicles are the same with
respect to the speed accuracy tolerance used during calibration. The odometer gear ratio is fixed
so that all are identical and have no error in the speedometer head.
Electronic digital operation is similar. It could use a drive cable or a speed sensor to drive the
speedometer/odometer. An electronic signal is sent from a speed sensor to the digital
speedometer/ odometer assembly. The speed sensor is driven by a transmission or a transaxle,
similar to a cable.
Several areas of concern that may affect speedometer/ odometer readings are tires, axle gear ratio
and speedometer/odometer drive and driven gears.
TIRES
Improper tire rolling radius and inflation pressure, temperature and size may contribute to
inaccurate system readings. System accuracy testing should be performed after the tires are set at
the correct pressure as shown on the safety compliance certification label. The tires should be
warmed for a short period. Best results are obtained on smooth, dry pavement while driving at a
constant speed within the posted speed limit.
AXLE/TRANSAXLE RATIO
The gear ratio of the rear axle or the final drive ratio of the transaxle must be known to select or
check if the proper speedometer/odometer drive and driven gears are present. Various gear ratios
are available, but usually are not a concern when dealing with speedometer/odometer concerns
unless the gear ratio has been changed.
WARNING: NEVER CORRECT SPEEDOMETER READINGS BY CHANGING GEARS UNLESS
THE ODOMETER IS ALSO OFF. DRIVE/DRIVEN GEARS
The speedometer/odometer drive gear is located inside the transmission, transaxle or transfer case
and is not easily accessed for change. The driven gear rotates the speedometer cable. Rear wheel
drive vehicles have several driven gears with various numbers of teeth available to correct input to
the speedometer/odometer head. Front wheel drive vehicles generally do not offer different gears
for correction.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The maximum allowable odometer system accuracy error is +/- 3.75% of the actual distance
traveled. Ford Motor vehicles are well within those limits.
The speed indication is biased high, except on police vehicles with certified calibration
speedometers/ odometers. As a general rule, the indicated speed is equal to or greater than the
actual speed. This is intended to protect the consumer against violating speed laws. Most customer
concerns are related to speedometers reading too high at true speeds between 50 MPH and 65
MPH (80 - 105 Km/h). At that speed range, the worst case errors may indicate a speed that is 10%
greater than true speed.
The speedometer head is an instrument which processes information sent to it by the rotating
speedometer cable. If the system components send the
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Speedometer/Odometer - Inaccurate Readings > Page 651
wrong number of revolution per mile to the speedometer head, an inaccurate speed reading and
amount of distanced traveled will be displayed. Since there is no error in the fixed gear ratio of the
speedometer head odometer, start by checking the accuracy of the odometer even if the customer
concern indicates a speed accuracy problem. Odometer accuracy can be checked by using roads
established at mile increments or a known local course. If roads with mile markers are used, a five
mile stretch is recommended to allow for inaccuracies. If an error is greater than 3.75%, a change
to the transmission drive/driven gear selection, tire size, or tire inflation may need attention. The
odometer should be checked again to verify any corrective action. If the indicated speed error
exceeds 10% between 50 MPH and 60 MPH (80 - 105 Km/h), replace the speedometer/odometer
assembly. Vehicles with transfer cases that have fluctuating readings may be due to slippage of
drive gears, parts not splined or loose yoke nuts.
If the vehicle has speed control, the speed accuracy can be checked using the verified odometer
vs. time. The formula is as follows:
3600 divided by TIME (seconds to cover one mile) = TRUE MPH (Km/h) EXAMPLES:
60 MPH (96 Km/h) requires 60 seconds to cover one mile
55 MPH (88 Km/h) requires 65 and 3/4 seconds to cover one mile
50 MPH (80 Km/h) requires 72 seconds to cover one mile
ARTICLE SUPERSEDED: 84-14-6, date 7/3/84
WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
OASIS CODES: 2300, 2310, 2400, 2500
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 8542 > Feb > 85 > Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Windows: Customer Interest Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Article No. 85-4-2
GLASS - DOOR AND VENT WINDOWS - EXCESSIVE EFFORTS TO OPEN - CORRECT
LUBRICATING PRODUCT
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK ALL
It has been found that the propellant within aftermarket aerosol spray lubricants attacks the
weatherstrip flocking adhesive and can cause high friction during glass cycling.
To prevent this condition, it is suggested that dealers only use Mini-Vent Lube (Part No.
D3AZ-19553-A) or Silicone Lubricant (Jelly) (Part No. COAZ-19553-A) as a lubricant for minimizing
door glass or vent window high and/or sticking glass operating afforts. These two aftermarket
lubricants are longer lasting and may be applied to the window and vent window weatherstrips
during Dealer Prep and/or normal customer service visits. Aerosol sprays should NOT be used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Windows: > 8542 > Feb > 85 > Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Windows: All Technical Service Bulletins Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Article No. 85-4-2
GLASS - DOOR AND VENT WINDOWS - EXCESSIVE EFFORTS TO OPEN - CORRECT
LUBRICATING PRODUCT
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK ALL
It has been found that the propellant within aftermarket aerosol spray lubricants attacks the
weatherstrip flocking adhesive and can cause high friction during glass cycling.
To prevent this condition, it is suggested that dealers only use Mini-Vent Lube (Part No.
D3AZ-19553-A) or Silicone Lubricant (Jelly) (Part No. COAZ-19553-A) as a lubricant for minimizing
door glass or vent window high and/or sticking glass operating afforts. These two aftermarket
lubricants are longer lasting and may be applied to the window and vent window weatherstrips
during Dealer Prep and/or normal customer service visits. Aerosol sprays should NOT be used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Windows: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light
Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Windows: > Page 671
Windows: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 8542 Date: 850221
Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Article No. 85-4-2
GLASS - DOOR AND VENT WINDOWS - EXCESSIVE EFFORTS TO OPEN - CORRECT
LUBRICATING PRODUCT
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK ALL
It has been found that the propellant within aftermarket aerosol spray lubricants attacks the
weatherstrip flocking adhesive and can cause high friction during glass cycling.
To prevent this condition, it is suggested that dealers only use Mini-Vent Lube (Part No.
D3AZ-19553-A) or Silicone Lubricant (Jelly) (Part No. COAZ-19553-A) as a lubricant for minimizing
door glass or vent window high and/or sticking glass operating afforts. These two aftermarket
lubricants are longer lasting and may be applied to the window and vent window weatherstrips
during Dealer Prep and/or normal customer service visits. Aerosol sprays should NOT be used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Technical Service Bulletin # 8542 Date: 850221
Door/Vent Windows - Excessive Efforts to Open
Article No. 85-4-2
GLASS - DOOR AND VENT WINDOWS - EXCESSIVE EFFORTS TO OPEN - CORRECT
LUBRICATING PRODUCT
FORD ALL
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL
LIGHT TRUCK ALL
MEDIUM/HEAVY TRUCK ALL
It has been found that the propellant within aftermarket aerosol spray lubricants attacks the
weatherstrip flocking adhesive and can cause high friction during glass cycling.
To prevent this condition, it is suggested that dealers only use Mini-Vent Lube (Part No.
D3AZ-19553-A) or Silicone Lubricant (Jelly) (Part No. COAZ-19553-A) as a lubricant for minimizing
door glass or vent window high and/or sticking glass operating afforts. These two aftermarket
lubricants are longer lasting and may be applied to the window and vent window weatherstrips
during Dealer Prep and/or normal customer service visits. Aerosol sprays should NOT be used.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: NONE WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Washer Fluid Level
Switch: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Customer Interest Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Washer Fluid
Level Switch: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light
Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Washer Fluid Level Switch: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid
Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Customer Interest Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"
Ford Courier Workshop Manual (L4-2299cc (1982))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Washer Fluid Level Switch: > 84219 > Oct > 84 > Wiper/Washer - Low
Fluid Warning Light Stays On
Washer Fluid Level Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Wiper/Washer - Low Fluid Warning Light
Stays On
Article No. 84-21-9
WIPER/WASHER - LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT STAYS ON
FORD ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
LINCOLN-MERCURY ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL CAR LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING
LIGHT
LIGHT TRUCKS ALL MODEL YEARS AND ALL LINES WITH LOW FLUID WARNING LIGHT
On some vehicles equipped with low fluid warning light, the light may stay on even when the
washer reservoir is full. This is caused by using washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B) that
has not been mixed with water according to the instructions. The undiluted washer solution is
absorbed by the float resulting in the float sinking.
When filling the washer reservoir with washer fluid concentrate (C9AZ-19550-A/B), the instructions
on the can must be followed. Mixing the concentrated washer fluid with water will stop the float
from sinking.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: None WARRANTY STATUS: "INFORMATION ONLY"